Feedback


Family 9113+01 IBM eServer p5 550 Model 550

IBM United States Sales Manual
Revised:  May 06, 2014.

Table of contents
TOC Link Product life cycle dates TOC Link Publications
TOC Link Abstract TOC Link Features
TOC Link Highlights TOC Link Accessories
TOC Link Description TOC Link Machine elements
TOC Link Models TOC Link Supplies
TOC Link Technical description  

 
Product life cycle dates
Type Model Announced Available Marketing Withdrawn Service Discontinued
9113-550 2004/07/132004/08/31 2006/05/31 -

Back to topBack to top
 
Abstract

IBM UNIX systems consist of the IBM eServer pSeries and IBM RS/6000 product lines. Providing unprecedented value, these innovative systems feature IBM's leading-edge technology and run the top-rated UNIX operating system, AIX. This broad prod workstations ideal for mechanical design; to mission-critical symmetric multiprocessing (SMP) servers for ERP, SCM, CRM, transaction processing, and Web serving; up to parallel RS/6000 SP systems that can handle demanding scientific and technical computing and business intelligence tasks. These platforms provide the power to create change and the flexibility to manage it, with thousands of applications that provide real value. More than 1,000,000 system businesses worldwide.

Model abstract 9113-550

The IBM eServer p5 550 Deskside and Rack-mount Server (9113-550) gives you new tools for managing e-business, greater application flexibility, and innovative technology -- all design e-business revolution. With its two processor positions, the p5-550 is available in 1-, 2-, and 4-way configurations.

The symmetric multiprocessor (SMP) uses state-of-the-art, 64-bit, copper-based POWER5 microprocessors. A 1-way processor card running at 1.5 GHz, or a 2-way processor card running at either 1.5 or 1.65 GHz are available. The 1-way processor card has no Level 3 cache while both 2-way processor cards have 36 MB of Level 3 cache. The base 512 MB, of main memory can be expanded to 64 GB for faster performance and exploitation of 64-bit addressing as us

The p5-550 contains up to 11 bays. There are four front-accessible, hot-swap-capable DASD bays in a minimum configuration with an additional four hot-swap-capable DASD bays optional. The eight DASD bays can accommodate up to 1174.4 GB of disk storage. Two of the remaining three bays are used for a DVD-ROM and a DVD-RAM, and the third bay can contain a tape drive.

Other integrated features include:

  • Five hot-swap 3.3V PCI-X slots or four hot-swap 3.3V PCI-X slots and one slot to support the Dual Port RIO-2

  • Service Processor

  • Two 10/100/1000 Ethernet Ports

  • Ultra320 SCSI controller with dual ports (internal) and optional RAID adapter

  • Two serial ports and two USB ports

  • Two HMC ports

  • Two remote I/O (RIO-2) ports

  • Hot-swap power and cooling

  • Redundant cooling

Dynamic logical partitioning (LPAR), with micropartitioning, and Capacity Upgrade on Demand (CUoD) are supported on the p5-550.

The p5-550 is added to the hardware Cluster 1600 running Cluster Systems Management (CSM) for V1.4 (AIX or Linux). For hardware control using CSM, an HMC is required.
Back to topBack to top
 

Highlights

See Model Highlights.

Model highlights 9113-550

The model 550 offers:

  • 64-bit scalability offering one 1-way POWER5 processor card running at 1.5 GHz, or one or two 2-way POWER5 processor card running at 1.5 or 1.65 GHz
  • Powerful, symmetric multiprocessing
  • Deskside or rack-mount configuration
  • Performance and capacity needed by demanding e-business applications
  • Up to 64 GB of memory
  • Up to 1174.4 GB of internal disk storage
  • Eight hot-swap disk bays and a maxi for feature expandability
  • Cluster 1600 enhancements
  • Two slimline media bays for DVD-ROM and DVD-RAM
  • One media bay for tape drive
  • Dynamic logical partitioning and optional Capacity Upgrade on Demand

Back to topBack to top
 
Description

Model 550

Summary of standard features:

  • Deskside or rack-mount (4 U) configurations

  • 1-way, 2-way and 4-way SMP design (one or two 2-way processor cards)

  • 1.5 or 1.65 GHz POWER5 64-bit processor
    • No L3 cache on 1-way 1.5 GHz processor card
    • 36 MB L3 cache with 2-way 1.5 or 1.65 GHz processor card

  • 512 MB of DDR-I 266 MHz ECC memory
    • Expandable to 64 GB

  • Eight hot-swap disk drive bays -- two 4-packs:
    • Four standard and four optional

  • Three media bays:
    • One DVD-ROM (optional)
    • One DVD-RAM (optional)
    • One tape drive (optional)

    Note: Either a DVD-ROM or DVD-RAM is required in a minimum configuration.

  • A maximum of five hot-swap PCI-X slots:

    • Four 64-bit, 3.3 volt, 133 MHz (long).

    • One 64-bit, 3.3 volt, 133 MHz (short). This slot can be used to support the Dual Port RIO-2 I/O Hub (#1806)

  • One 4-pack disk drive enclosure

  • One media backplane

  • Integrated:
    • Dual 10/100/1000 Ethernet
    • Ultra320 SCSI controller with dual ports (internal) and optional RAID adapter
    • Service processor
    • Hot-swap and redundant fans
    • Two USB ports
    • Two serial ports
    • Two HMC ports
    • Two remote I/O (RIO-2) ports

  • One power supply, 1475 watt AC, base (redundant power optional)

  • AIX V5.2 or V5.3, or later, or SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later, or Red Hat Enterprise

The minimum model 550 configuration must include a processor, memory, power supply, hard disk drive, a disk drive enclosure, a DVD-ROM or DVD-RAM, a media backplane card, a power cord, one or two configuration indicators, two processor activations, and a language group specify. The defaults, if no choice is made, are:

     1-way, 1.5 GHz Processor        (#5239)
     One processor entitlement      (1 x #7601)
     Processor power regulator       (#7876)
     512 MB memory DIMM              (#4443)
     Power supply, 1475 watt AC,
     base                            (#7889)
     Disk drive 36.4 GB hard drive   (#3273)
     4-pack disk drive enclosure     (#6592)
     DVD-ROM                         (#2640)
     Media backplane                 (#7877)
     Configuration indicators        #7887 for deskside system;
                                     #7886 and #7162 or #7163
                                     for rack-mount system)
     Language group specify          (#9300 or 97xx)
     Power cord                      (#6458, #6460, #6469-#6479, #6487,
                                     #6488, #6493-#6496)
 

A keyboard, mouse, graphics adapter, and monitor are available as options.

IBM eServer P5 550 Value Paks

Note: Value Paks are only available as Initial Order.

If you order a model 550 with the 1-way POWER5 1.5 GHz processor (#5239), the 2-way POWER5 1.5 GHz processor (#5264), or the 2-way POWER5 1.65 GHz processor (#5237) and a minimum configuration of memory and disks, you will qualify for a processor entitlement or activation at no additional charge. The number of processors, total memory, and quantity/size of disk are the only features that determine if a customer is entitled to processor entitlements or activations at no additional charge. You will also be entitled to a discounted AIX operating system license or may choose to purchase the system with no operating system. The discounted AIX operating system license is processed via a feature code on AIX.

The minimum criteria for processor entitlements or activations at no additional charge are 2 GB of memory per active processor and two 73.4 GB hard disk drives.

You may make changes to the standard features as needed and still qualify for processor entitlements or activations at no additional charge, and a discounted AIX operating system license. Selection of memory and/or disk drives smaller than those defined as the Value Pak minimums will disqualify the order as a Value Pak.

p5 550 Express Value Paks for the 1.5 GHz Processors

  • 1-way 1.5 GHz processor (1 x #5239)
  • 2 GB memory (Default: 1 x #4447)
  • 2 x 73.4 GB disk drive (#3274)

Note: Receive one processor entitlement (#8463) at no additional charge. One processor is entitled.

  • 2-way 1.5 GHz processor (1 x #5264)
  • 4 GB memory (Default: 2 x #4447)
  • 2 x 73.4 GB disk drive (#3274)
  • 1 standard acitivation (1 x

Note: Receive one processor activation (#8465) at no additional charge. Two processors are activated.

  • 2 x 2-way 1.5 GHz processor (2 x
  • 8 GB memory (Default: 4 x #4447)
  • 2 x 73.4 GB disk drive (#3274)
  • 2 standard activations (2 x #7603)

Note: Receive Two processor activations (#8465) at no additional charge. Four processors are activated.

p5 550 Value Paks for the 1.65 GHz Processor

  • 2-way 1.65 GHz processor (1 x #5237)
  • 4 GB memory (Default: 2 x #4447)
  • 2 x 73.4 GB disk drive (#3274)
  • 1 standard activation (1 x #7871)

Note: Receive one processor activation (#8450) at no additional charge. Two processors are activated.

  • 2 x 2-way 1.65 GHz processor (2 x #5237)
  • 8 GB memory (Default: 4 x #4447)
  • 2 x 73.4 GB disk drive (#3274)
  • 2 standard activations (2 x #7871)

Note: Receive two processor activations (#8450) at no additional charge. Four processors are activated.

Dynamic Logical Partitioning

The dynamic logical partitioning (LPAR) function provides enhanced resource management for the p5-550 server. Dynamic LPAR allows available system resources to be quickly and easily configured across multiple logical partitions to meet the rapidly changing needs of your business.

Dynamic LPAR also allows you to add new system resources such as newly activated CUoD processors or new hot-plug PCI adapters into your system's configuration without requiring a reboot. As many as four LPARs are supported in a 4-way model 550 without the Advanced POWER Virtualization feature (#7941). If the Advanced POWER Virtualization feature (#7941) is installed in the system, up to 10 dynamic LPARs per processor (20 per 2-way processor card) are supported in the stand-alone SMP server configuration on the model p5-550. Dyanmic LPAR requires the use of a Hardware Management Console (HMC).

Dynamic logical partitioning is supported by the following levels of the AIX and Linux operating systems:

  • AIX 5L for POWER V5.2, or later
  • SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later
  • Not supported by current version of Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS for POWER Version 3.

An IBM 7310-CR2 Rack-Mounted HMC or 7310-C03 Desktop HMC is required to manage POWER5 processor-based servers implementing partitioning. Multiple partitions and multiple POWER5 processor-based servers can be supported by an HMC, located locally or remotely attached to the IBM eServer.

The HMC is not required for a partition to run, but is required for an IBM eServer p5-550 system to create, define, and change the partition.

Capacity On Demand (CoD)

Capacity on Demand (CoD) adds operational and configuration flexibility for IBM eServer pSeries systems. Available for a fee, CoD allows additional processors to be added as they are needed. Processors can be brought online to meet increasing workload demands. If the system is configured for dynamic LPAR, this can be accomplished without impacting operations. This feature has significant value for users who want to upgrade without disruption, enhance their system RAS (reliability, availability, serviceability) characteristics, or simply grow with a finer level of granularity. The CoD features allow a system to be manufactured (or upgraded in your locale) with inactive processors. The hardware is delivered with the processors built in, ready to be activated when needed. It can turned on by ordering the type of activation desired, at which time the user is provided an activation code to enable the processors.

An additional benefit of the CoD offering is dynamic processor sparing. For environments with CoD, dynamic processor sparing allows inactive processors to act as dynamic spares. An inactive processor is activated if a failing processor reaches a predetermined error threshold, thus helping to maintain performance and improve system availability. Starting with AIX 5L v5.2, this capability is offered on pSeries servers with CoD to help minimize the impact to server performance caused by a failed processor. Dynamic processor sparing will happen dynamically and automatically when using dynamic logical partitioning (DLPAR) and the failing processor is detected prior to failure. If a failure is not detected DLPAR is not being used, a reboot of the system or partition activates an alternate processor from the inactive spares. The user can then reestablish required performance levels without waiting for parts to arrive on-site. Dynamic processor sparing does not require the purchase of an activation code; it requires only that the system have inactive CoD.

Types Of CoD

After a system with the CoD features is delivered, they can be activated in the following ways:

  • Permanent Capacity Upgrade on Demand (CUoD)
  • On/Off Capacity on Demand
  • Reserve Capacity on Demand
  • Trial Capacity on Demand

Permanent CUoD

The Capacity Upgrade on Demand (CUoD) (feature number 5237) for processors on the p5-550 allows you to have inactive processors installed in your system that can be easily activated as your business needs require. You must install two 2-way processors and activate at least two processors. When you need additional processing power, you simply order activation features that increase the number of active processors in your system in increments of one. Feature number 7871 (minimum of 2, maximum of 4) is ordered as needed to activate processors. CUoD for processors on the 550 is implemented via a keyed approach. When an activation order is received, you will receive an encrypted key, which enables the system's machine code to activate the processors.

The Capacity Upgrade on Demand is supported by the following levels of the AIX and Linux operating systems:

  • AIX 5L for POWER V5.2, or later
  • SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later
  • CUoD is not supported by Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS for POWER Version 3

An IBM 7310-CR2 Rack-Mounted HMC or 7310-C03 Desktop HMC is required to manage POWER5 processor-based servers implementing Capacity on Demand. Multiple POWER5 processor-based servers can be supported by an HMC, located locally or remotely attached to the IBM eServer.

On/Off CoD

On/off CoD (#7930 and #7931) enables users to temporarily activate processors. This offering provides a system manager an interface to manage the activation and deactivation of resources. A monitor that resides on the server logs the usage activity and periodically reports this information back to IBM. A usage bill is then generated based on the selected quantity and duration of processor and memory resources. Billing increments are in Processor Day and Memory (1 GB) Days.

On/off CoD requires that a contract be signed by the customer the first time that the On/off CoD feature is ordered.

Reserve CoD

(#7934) represents an "autonomic" way to activate temporary capacity. Reserve CoD enables the user to place a quantity of inactive processors into the server's Shared Processor Pool which then become available to the pool's resource manager. When the server recognizes the number of base (purchased/active) processors assigned across uncapped partitions have been 100% utilized, and at least 10% of an additional processor is needed, then a Processor Day (good for a 24-hour period) is charged against the Reserve CoD account balance. Another Processor Day will be charged for each additional processor put into use based on the 10% utilization rule. After a 24-hour period elapses, and there is no longer a need for the additional performance, no Processor Days will be charged until the next performance spike. Reserve COD requires Advanced POWER Virtualization (#7941).

Note: Not supported by AIX 5L for POWER V5.2.

Trial CoD

Trial Capacity on Demand (Trial CoD) is a function delivered with all pSeries servers supporting CoD. Those servers with inactive CUoD processors or memory will be capable of using a one-time, no-cost activation for a maximum period of 30 consecutive days. This enhancement allows for benchmarking of CoD resources or can be used to provide immediate access to inactive resources when the purchase is pending.

Advanced Power Virtualization

Advanced POWER Virtualization (#7941) allows customers to create partitions in units of less than 1 CPU (sub-CPU LPARs) and allows the same system I/O to be virtually added to these partitions. The Optional feature, available for a fee, also includes a software component that provides cross partition workload management. Advanced POWER Virtualization combines three components:

  • Firmware feature to turn on micro-partitioning (#7941)
  • Software feature to activate the I/O Virtualization
  • Software feature providing partition load management

At initial order entry, selecting feature number 7941 will result in micropartitioning to be enabled during manufacture and the enabling software media and publications to be shipped to the customer. When ordering feature number 7941 as an MES, on an IBM Web site and the customer must retrieve it and install it on the system. The IBM Web site is:

http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/openpower/cod

Other Features of Advanced Power Virtualization

  • If any processors in a system have the Virtualization feature, all active processors must have it.

  • Once the Virtualization feature is installed in a system, it cannot be removed.

  • Virtual Ethernet and Virtual Storage are part of Advanced POWER Virtualization.

  • Partition Load Manager provides automated CPU and memory resource management across AIX 5.2/5.3 logical partitions.

Advanced POWER Virtualization is supported by the following levels of the AIX and Linux operating systems:

  • AIX 5L for POWER V5.3, or later
  • SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later
  • Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS for POWER Version 3

Reliability, Availability, and Serviceability (RAS)

Reliability, fault tolerance, and data integrity

The reliability of the model 550 system starts with components, devices, and subsystems that are designed to be fault tolerant. During the design and development process, subsystems go through rigorous verification and integration testing processes. During system manufacturing, systems go through a thorough testing process to help ensure highest product quality level.

The model 550 system L3 cache and system memory offers ECC (error checking and correcting) fault-tolerant features. ECC is designed to correct environmentally induced, single-bit, intermittent memory failures and single-bit hard failures. With ECC, the likelihood of memory failures will be substantially reduced. ECC also provides double-bit memory error detection that helps protect data integrity in the event of a double-bit memory failure. System memory also provides 4-bit packet error detection that helps to protect data integrity in the event of a DRAM chip failure. The system bus, I/O bus, and PCI buses are designed with parity error detection.

Disk mirroring and disk controller duplexing capability are also provided by the AIX operating system. Linux supports DASD mirroring (RAID 1). This is supported in software using the md driver. There are also hardware RAID adapters supported under Linux that support mirroring.

The Journaled File System maintains file system consistency and reduces the likelihood of data loss when the system is abnormally halted due to a power failure.

PCI extended error handling (EEH)(3)

In the past, PCI bus parity errors caused a global machine check interrupt, which eventually required a system reboot to continue. In the POWER5 systems, new I/O drawer hardware, system firmware, and AIX interaction have been designed to allow transparent recovery of intermittent PCI bus parity errors and graceful transition to the I/O device available state in the case of a permanent parity error in the PCI bus. This mechanism is called the PCI extended error handling (EEH). EEH-enabled adapters respond to a special data packet generated from the affected PCI slot hardware by calling system firmware, which will examine the affected bus, allow the device driver to reset it, and continue without a system reboot. Currently, Linux does not support the EEH behavior. In the event of a PCI error, the system will machine check and a reboot will be required to continue.

Note: (3) Indicates that this RAS function is not supported under Linux.

Memory error correction extensions

The standard memory has single-error-correct and double-error detect ECC circuitry designed to correct single-bit memory failures. The double-bit detection is designed to help maintain data integrity by detecting and reporting multiple errors beyond what the ECC circuitry can correct. The memory chips are organized such that the failure of any specific memory module only affects a single bit within an ECC word (bit scattering), thus allowing for error correction and continued operation in the presence of a complete chip failure (Chipkill recovery).

The memory also utilizes memory scrubbing and thresholding to determine when spare memory modules, within each bank of memory, if available, should be used to replace ones that have exceeded their threshold value (dynamic bit steering).

Redundancy for array self-healing

Although the most likely failure event in a processor is a soft single-bit error in one of its caches, there are other events that can occur, and they need to be distinguished from one another. For the L1, L2 and L3 caches and their directories, hardware and firmware keep track of whether permanent errors are being corrected beyond a threshold. If exceeded, a deferred repair error log is created. Additional run-time availability actions, such as CPU vary off(4) or L3 cache line delete, are also initiated.

L1 and L2 caches and L2 and L3 directories on the POWER5 chip are manufactured with spare bits in their arrays that can be accessed via programmable steering logic to replace faulty bits in the respective arrays. This is analogous to the redundant bit steering employed in main storage as a mechanism that is designed to help avoid physical repair, and is also implemented in POWER5 systems. The steering logic is activated during processor initialization and is initiated by the built-in system-test (BIST) at power-on time.

L3 cache redundancy is implemented at the cache line granularity level. Exceeding correctable error thresholds while running causes invocation of a dynamic L3 cache line delete function.

Service Processor

The Service Processor included in the model 550 gives you an immediate means to diagnose, check status, and sense operational conditions of a remote system, even when the main processor is inoperable.

The Service Processor enables firmware and operating system surveillance, several remote power controls, environmental monitoring (only critical errors are supported under Linux), reset, and boot features, remote maintenance and diagnostic activities, including console mirroring. The Service Processor can place calls to report surveillance failures, critical environmental faults, and critical processing faults.

Fault monitoring functions

  • BIST (built-in self-test) and POST (power-on self-test) check processor, L3 cache, memory, and associated hardware required for proper booting of the operating system, every time the system is powered on. If a non-critical error is detected or if the errors occur in the resources that can be removed from the system configuration, the booting process is designed to proceed to completion. The errors are logged in the system nonvolatile RAM (NVRAM).

  • Disk drive fault tracking can alert the system administrator of an impending disk failure before it impacts customer operation.

  • The AIX or Linux log (where hardware and software failures are recorded and analyzed by Error Log Analysis (ELA) routine) warns the system administrator about the causes of system problems. This also enables IBM service representatives to bring along probable replacement hardware components when a service call is placed, thus minimizing system repair time.

Mutual surveillance

The Service Processor can monitor the operation of the firmware during the boot process, and it can monitor the operating system for loss of control. It also allows the operating system to monitor for Service Processor activity. The Service Processor can take appropriate action, including calling for service, when it detects the firmware or the operating system has lost control. Likewise, the operating system can request a Service Processor repair action, if necessary.

Environmental monitoring functions

  • Temperature monitoring increases the fan speed rotation when ambient temperature is above the normal operating range.

  • Temperature monitoring warns the system administrator of potential environmental related-problems (for example, air conditioning and air circulation around the system) so that appropriate corrective actions can be taken before a critical failure threshold is reached. It also performs an orderly system shutdown when the operating temperature exceeds the critical level.

  • Fan speed monitoring provides a warning and an orderly system shutdown when the speed is out of operational specification.

  • Voltage monitoring provides warning and an orderly system shutdown when the voltages are out of operational specification.

Error handling and reporting

In the unlikely event of system hardware or environmentally induced failure, the system run-time error capture capability systematically analyzes the hardware error signature to determine the cause of failure. The analysis result will be stored in system NVRAM. When the system can be successfully rebooted either manually or automatically, the error will be reported to the AIX or Linux operating system. Error Log Analysis (ELA) can be used to display the failure cause and the physical location of failing hardware.

With the integrated Service Processor, the system has the ability to automatically send out an alert via phone line to a pager or call for service in the event of critical system failure. A hardware fault will also turn on the two Attention Indicators (one located on the front of the system unit and the other on the rear of the system unit) to alert the user of an internal hardware problem. The indicator may also be turned on by the operator as a tool to allow system identification. For identification, the indicators will flash, whereas the indicator will be on solid when an error condition occurs.

Availability enhancement functions

  • The auto-restart (reboot) option, when enabled, can reboot the system automatically following an unrecoverable software error, software hang, hardware failure, or environmentally induced (AC power) failure.

Serviceability

The model 550 is designed for customer setup of the machine and for subsequent addition of most features (adapters/devices)(4). For a fee, IBM Service can perform the installation.

  • The model 550 allows customers to replace service parts (Customer Replaceable Unit) if they desire to do so. To accomplish this, the model 550 has incorporated LEDs that will indicate the parts needing to be replaced.

  • The model 550 allows support personnel to remotely log into a system to review error logs and perform remote maintenance. The model 550 Service Processor enables the analysis of a system that will not boot.

  • The diagnostics consist of Stand-alone Diagnostics, which are loaded from the DVD-ROM drive, and Online Diagnostics.

  • Online Diagnostics(3) when installed, are resident with AIX on the disk or system. They can be booted in single-user mode (service mode), run in maintenance mode, or run concurrently (concurrent mode) with other applications. They have access to the AIX Error Log and the AIX Configuration Data.

    • Service mode allows checking of system devices and features.

    • Concurrent mode allows the normal system functions to continue while selected resources are being checked.

    • Maintenance mode allows checking of most system resources.

  • For results of Service Processor tests, access the error log from the Service Processor menu.

Note: (3) Indicates that this RAS function is not supported under Linux.

Note: (4) Indicates that this RAS function is only available for a Linux operating system running the 2.6 kernel.

Service Agent

The Service Agent is available at no additional charge. When installed on an IBM eServer system, the Service Agent can enhance IBM's ability to provide the system with maintenance service.

The Service Agent:

  • Monitors and analyzes system errors, and if needed, can automatically place a service call to IBM without customer intervention

  • Can help reduce the effect of business disruptions due to unplanned system outages and failures

  • Performs problem analysis on a subset of hardware-related problems and, with customer authorization, can report automatically the results to IBM Service

Online Customer Support (OCS)(3)

OCS for hardware problem reporting may be performed via remote login by IBM eServer specialists using normal AIX facilities. The Service Agent software can also be used for this capability

AIX Support offerings will be under AIXSERV and Electronic Service Agent.

Note: (3) Indicates that this RAS function is not supported under Linux.
Back to topBack to top
 

Models

Model summary matrix

Model Processor Type Clock Rate System Memory Internal Storage Slots/Bays
550 POWER5 1.5 GHz 512 MB/64 GB 36.4 GB/1174.4 GB 5 slots/7 bays standard with additional 4 optional bays
550 POWER5 1.65 GHz 1 GB/64 GB 36.4 GB/1174.4 GB 5 slots/7 bays standard with additional 4 optional bays

Customer setup (CSU)

No for feature numbers 6312, 2877 and 4353. Yes for all others.

Devices supported

The following external machine types are supported on the indicated models for MT 9113.

This list is not all inclusive. Many devices are supported through standard ports. Please refer to the sales manual of the external machine type and the list of supported devices in the appropriate section of the AIX sales manual for further attach support information.

          |5|  X = SUPPORTED DEVICE
          |5|
          |0|
   MT-MOD | |        DESCRIPTION
 ---------|-|-----------------------------------------------------------
 ---------+-+--------SWITCH---------------------------------------------
 - - - - -|-|- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
 2031-016 |X| McDATA Model 016 Departmental ES-3032 Fabric Switch
 2031-032 |X| McDATA Model 032 Departmental ES-3032 Fabric Switch
 2031-216 |X| McData ES-3216 Fabric Switch
 2031-224 |X| McData IBM 2031 Model 224 Fabric Switch
 2031-232 |X| McData ES-3232 Fabric Switch
 2031-L00 |X| McDATA Model L00 ES-1000 Loop Switch
 2032-001 |X| McDATA ED-5000 Enterprise Fibre Channel Switch
 2032-064 |X| McDATA Model 064 Enterprise Fibre Channel Director
 2032-140 |X| 2032 McDATA Intrepid 6140 Enterprise Fibre Channel
          | |      Director Model 140
 2032-C40 |X| Cabinet for McDATA Intrepid 6064 Enterprise Fibre Channel
          | |      Director
 2042-001 |X| Inrange FC/9000 64-port Fibre Channel Director
 2042-128 |X| Inrange FC/9000 128-port Fibre Channel Director
 2042-256 |X| INRANGE FC/9000-256 FC Director
 2061-020 |X| Cisco Systems MDS 9120 Fabric Switch (IBM Resell)
 2061-040 |X| Cisco Systems MDS 9140 Fabric Switch (IBM Resell)
 2062-D01 |X| Cisco MDS-9216 Multilayer Fabric Switch
 2062-D07 |X| Cisco MDS 9509 Multilayer Director Switch (Data Center
          | |      Model)
 2062-T07 |X| Cisco 9509 Multilayer Director Switch (Telecom Model - DC
          | |      Power)
 2109-F16 |X| IBM TotalStorage SAN Switch Model M16
 2109-F32 |X| TotalStorage SAN Switch - 2109 Model F32
 2109-M12 |X| IBM TotalStorage SAN Switch Model M12
 7042-C40 |X| Inrange FC/9000 Fibre Channel Director
          | |
 ---------+-+--------DISK-----------------------------------------------
 - - - - -|-|- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
 1710-100 |X| IBM TotalStorage FAXtT100 Storage Server
 1710-10U |X| IBM TotalStorage FAStT EXP100 Storage Expansion Unit
 1722-60U |X| FAStT600 Storage Server
 1722-6LU |X| TotalStorage DS4300 Midrange Disk System
 1740-1RU |X| TotalStorage FAStT EXP700 Storage Expansion Unit
 1742-1RU |X| TotalStorage FAStT700 Storage Server
 1742-90U |X| FAStT900 Storage Server
 2005-H08 |X| IBM TotalStorage SAN Switch Model H08
 2005-H16 |X| IBM TotalStorage SAN Switch Model H16
 2076-112 |X| The IBM 2076 Storwize V7000 Control Enclosure 112
 2076-124 |X| The IBM 2076 Storwize V7000 Control Enclosure 124
 2076-212 |X| The IBM 2076 Storwize V7000 Control Enclosure 212
 2076-224 |X| The IBM 2076 Storwize V7000 Control Enclosure 224
 2104-DS4 |X| IBM TOTALSTORAGE EXPANDABLE STORAGE PLUS U320 MODELS DS4
 2104-DU3 |X| Expandable Storage Plus Model DU3
 2104-TS4 |X|  IBM TOTALSTORAGE EXPANDABLE STORAGE PLUS U320 MODELS TS4
 2104-TU3 |X| Expandable Storage Plus Model TU3
 2105-750 |X| IBM TotalStorage Enterprise Storage Server Model 750
 2105-800 |X| TotalStorage Enterprise Storage Server Model 800
 2105-F10 |X| IBM Enterprise Storage Server Model F10
 2105-F20 |X| IBM Enterprise Storage Server Model F20
 2109-M14 |X| IBM TotalStorage SAN Switch Model M14
 3542-2RU |X| IBM FAStT200 Storage Server Model 2RU
 3542-2RX |X| IBM FAStT200 Storage Server Model 2RU (EMEA)
 3552-1RU |X| IBM TotalStorage FAStT500 Storage Server
 3552-1RX |X| IBM TotalStorage FAStT500 Storage Server (EMEA)
 3560-1RU |X| IBM TotalStorage FAStT EXP500 Storage Expansion Unit
 3560-1RX |X| IBM TotalStorage FAStT EXP500 Storage Expansion Unit
          | |      (EMEA)
 7133-D40 |X| IBM Serial Disk System Advanced Model D40
 7133-T40 |X| IBM Serial Disk System Advanced Model T40
 7204-518 |X| IBM 7204 18 GB External Disk Drive
 7204-536 |X| IBM 7204 36 GB External Disk Drive
 7204-573 |X| IBM 7204 External Disk Drive Model 573
          | |
 ---------+-+--------DISPLAYS-------------------------------------------
 - - - - -|-|- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
 6555-763 |X| P70 17" COLOR DISPLAY
 6555-764 |X| P70 17" COLOR DISPLAY
 6555-773 |X| P200 UV-N COLOR MONITOR
 6555-774 |X| P200 UV-N COLOR MONITOR
 6555-803 |X| P201 UV-N COLOR MONITOR
 7310-C03 |X| IBM 7310 Model C03 Hardware Management Console
 7310-CR2 |X| IBM 7310 Model CR2 Hardware Management Console
 7315-C01 |X| IBM 7315 Model C01 Hardware Management Console
 7315-C02 |X| IBM 7315 Model C02 Hardware Management Console
 7315-CR2 |X| IBM 7315 Model CR2 Hardware Management Console
 7316-TF3 |X| IBM 7316-TF3 Rack Mounted Flat Panel Display
 9513-AG2 |X| IBM T55A 15" TFT LCD COLOR MONITO
 9513-AW1 |X| IBM T55A 15" TFT LCD COLOR MONITOR
 9419-HB7 |X| IBM ThinkVision L191p 19-inch LCD Flat-panel Monitor
 9516-B03 |X| 16.1" TFT LCD DISPLAY
 9516-B04 |X| 16.1" TFT LCD DISPLAY
 
----------+-+------------OPTICAL----------------------------------------
- - - - - |-|- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
 3996-032 |X| IBM System Storage Model 032
 3996-080 |X| IBM System Storage Model 080
 3996-174 |X| IBM System Storage Model 174
          | |
 ---------+-+--------STORAGE NETWORK DEVICES----------------------------
 - - - - -|-|- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
 1710-10U |X| IBM 1710 TotalStorage FAStT EXP100 Storage Expansion Unit
 2145-4F2 |X| IBM TotalStorage SAN Volume Controller Storage Engine
 2146-V1A |X| IBM TotalStorage 2146 SAN Integration Server
          | |
 ---------+-+--------SCSI DEVICES---------------------------------------
 - - - - -|-|- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
 7210-020 |X| IBM CR-ROM Model 020
 7210-025 |X| 4.7GB DVDRAM Drive
 7210-030 |X| IBM DVD-RAM Drive Model 030
          | |
 ---------+-+--------TAPE-----------------------------------------------
 - - - - -|-|- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
 3494-B10 |X| IBM TotalStorage Virtual Tape Server (VTS) Model B10
 3494-B18 |X| IBM Magstar Virtual Tape Server  Model B18
 3494-B20 |X| IBM TotalStorage Virtual Tape Server (VTS) Model B20
 3494-D10 |X| IBM TotalStorage Enterprise Tape Drive Expansion Model D10
 3494-D12 |X| IBM Magstar Tape Library Model D12
 3494-D14 |X| IBM TotalStorage Enterprise Tape Drive Expansion Model D14
 3494-D22 |X| IBM TotalStorage Enterprise Automated Tape Library
          | |      3494-D22
 3494-D24 |X| IBM TotalStorage Enterprise Automated Tape Library
          | |      3494-D24
 3494-HA1 |X| IBM TotalStorage Enterprise High Availability Tape Frame
          | |      Model HA1
 3494-L10 |X| IBM TotalStorage Enterprise Tape Library Model L10
 3494-L12 |X| IBM Magstar Tape Library Model L12
 3494-L14 |X| IBM TotalStorage Enterprise Tape Library Model L14
 3494-L22 |X| IBM TotalStorage Enterprise Automated Tape Library
          | |      3494-L22
 3577-L5U |X| IBM System Storage TS3400 Tape Library
 3580-H11 |X| Linear Tape Open (LTO) Bridge Box (HVD)
 3580-H13 |X| LTO Ultrium Tape Drive
 3580-H23 |X| IBM Total Storage Ultrium 2 Tape Drive Model H23
 3580-L11 |X| Linear Tape Open (LTO) Bridge Box (LVD)
 3580-L13 |X| LTO Ultrium Tape Drive
 3580-L23 |X| IBM Total Storage Ultrium 2 Tape Drive Model L23
 3581-F28 |X| IBM TotalStorage Ultrium Tape Autoloader 3581 Model F28
 3581-H13 |X| LTO Ultrium Tape Autoloader
 3581-H17 |X| Linear Tape Open (LTO) Autoloader (HVD)
 3581-H23 |X| IBM TOTALSTORAGE ULTRIUM TAPE AUTOLOADER 3581 MODELS H23
 3581-L13 |X| LTO Ultrium Tape Autoloader
 3581-L17 |X| Linear Tape Open (LTO) Autoloader (LVD)
 3581-L23 |X| IBM TotalStorage Ultrium Tape Autoloader 3581 Model L23
 3581-L28 |X| IBM Total Storage Ultrium Tape U2 Autoloader
 3582-L23 |X| IBM TotalStorage Ultrium Tape Autoloader 3582 Model L23
 3583-L18 |X| Linear Tape Open (LTO) Tape Library - Scalable
 3583-L36 |X| Linear Tape Open (LTO) Tape Library - Scalable
 3583-L72 |X| Linear Tape Open (LTO) Tape Library - Scalable
 3584-D32 |X| IBM Ultrium 3584 Ultra-Scalable Tape Library - Base Frame
 3584-L22 |X| IBM Ultrium 3584 Ultra-Scalable Tape Library Model L22
 3584-L32 |X| IBM Ultrium 3584 Ultra-Scalable Tape Library - Expansion
          | |      Frame
 3584-L52 |X| IBM Ultrium 3584 Ultra-Scalable Tape Library Model L52
 3590-B11 |X| IBM Magstar Tape Subsystem Model B11
 3590-B1A |X| IBM Magstar Tape Subsystem Model B1A
 3590-C12 |X| IBM Magstar Silo Compatible Frame Model C1A
 3590-E11 |X| Magstar Tape Subsystem
 3590-E1A |X| Magstar Tape Subsystem
 3590-H11 |X| IBM TotalStorage Enterprise Tape Drive 3590 Model H11
 3590-H1A |X| IBM TotalStorage Enterprise Tape Drive 3590 Model H1A
 3592-C20 |X| IBM TOTALSTORAGE SILO COMPATIBLE TAPE DRIVE FRAME 3592-C20
 3592-E05 |X| IBM System Storage TS1120 Tape Drive
 3592-J1A |X| IBM TOTALSTORAGE ENTERPRISE TAPE DRIVE 3592 MODEL J1A
 7205-440 |X| IBM 7205 Digital Linear Tape Library Model 440
 7205-550 |X|External Digital Linear Tape Drive
 7206-220 |X| IBM 20GB External 4MM DDS-4 Tape Drive Model 220
 7206-336 |X| IBM 36GB External Tape Drive Model 336
 7206-VX2 |X| IBM 7206-VX2 External Tape Drive
 7206-VX3 |X| IBM 7206-VX3 External Tape Drive
 7207-122 |X| IBM 4GB External SLR5 QIC Tape Drive Model 122
 7207-330 |X| 7207-330 IBM Tape Drive
 7208-341 |X| IBM 20GB External 8MM Tape Drive Model 341
 7208-345 |X| IBM 7208 Model 345 60GB External 8MM Tape Drive
 7212-102 |X| 1U Dual-bay Storage Device Enclosure (Tape of DVD)
 7212-103 |X| IBM 7212-103 Storage Tape & DVD Enclosure Exp Model
 7212-312 |X| 1U UXA Tape Autoloader
 7332-220 |X| IBM 4MM DDS-4 Tape Cartridge Autoloader Model 220
 7334-410 |X| IBM 7334 Model 410 8MM Tape Library (MAM2 4x30)
 7337-360 |X| IBM 7337 Digital Linear Tape Library Model 360
          | |
 ---------+-+--------EXPANSION CABINETS---------------------------------
 - - - - -|-|- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
 2032-C36 |X| McDATA Model 0C3 FC-512 Cabinet for McDATA Directors and
          | |      Fabric Switch
 2042-C40 |X| Inrange 40U Cabinet
 2109-C36 |X| IBM TotalStorage San Cabinet C36
 7014-T00 |X| 1.8 Meter System Rack - 36U
 7014-T42 |X| 2.0 Meter System Rack - 42U
 7031-D24 |X| Ultra 320 SCSI Expandable Disk Storage Enclosures
 7031-T24 |X| Ultra 320 SCSI Expandable Disk Storage Enclosures
 7311-D20 |X| IBM Rack-Mounted High-Density Expansion Drawer
          | |
 ---------+-+--------SERVICES-------------------------
 - - - - -|-|- - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -
 0463-001 |X| Software Customization (CCS)
 0463-002 |X| Center for Customized Solutions (CCS)
 

The following TotalStorage external machine types are supported on the indicated models for MT 9110. This list is not all inclusive. Many devices are supported through standard ports. Please refer to the sales manual of the TotalStorage external machine type and the list of supported devices in the appropriate section of the AIX sales manual for further attach support information.

          |5|  X = SUPPORTED DEVICE
          |5|
          |0|
          | |
 MT-MOD   | |        DESCRIPTION
 -----------------------------------------------------------------
 2861-001 |X| IBM 2861 SystemStorage N5000 Model 001
 2863-A10 |X| IBM 2863 SystemStorage N3700 Model A10
 2863-A20 |X| IBM 2863 SystemStorage N3700 Model A20
 2864-A10 |X| IBM 2864 SystemStorage N5000 Model A10
 2864-A20 |X| IBM 2864 SystemStorage N5000 Model A20
 2865-A10 |X| IBM 2865 SystemStorage N5000 Model A10
 2865-A20 |X| IBM 2865 SystemStorage N5000 Model A20
 2870-631 |X| IBM 2870 TotalStorage N Series Model 631
 2870-632 |X| IBM 2870 TotalStorage N Series Model 632
 2870-641 |X| IBM 2870 TotalStorage N Series Model 641
 2870-642 |X| IBM 2870 TotalStorage N Series Model 642
 2870-651 |X| IBM 2870 TotalStorage N Series Model 651
 2870-652 |X| IBM 2870 TotalStorage N Series Model 652
 

The following feature availability matrix for MT 9113 uses the letter "A" to indicate features that are available and orderable on the specified models. "S" indicates a feature that is supported on the new model during a model conversion; these features will work on the new model, but additional quantities of these features cannot be ordered on the new model; they can only be removed. "N" indicates that the feature is not supported on the new model and must be removed during the model conversion. As additional features are announced, supported, or withdrawn, this list will be updated. Please check with your Marketing Representative for additional information.

        |5| A = AVAILABLE  S = SUPPORTED
        |5| N = NOT SUPPORTED, MUST BE REMOVED
        |0|
        | |
FEAT/PN | |        DESCRIPTION
--------|-|-----------------------------------------
0050    |A| IBM Express Seller Indicator
0265    |A| AIX Partition Specify
0266    |A| Linux Partition Specify
0983    |A| US TAA Compliance Indicator
0986    |A| CCS Customer Service Specify (US)
1806    |S| Dual Port RIO-2 I/O Hub
1809    |S| GX Dual-port 4x IB HCA
1820    |A| PCI-X Dual-port 4x IB HCA
1835    |S| 3 meter 4x IB Cable
1836    |S| 8 meter 4x IB Cable
1839    |A| 1.5 meter 4x Cable
2114    |S| PCI SCSI Adapter 16-Bit Differential External Y Cable
2118    |S| Converter Cable, VHDCI to P, Mini-68 pin to 68 pin, 0.3M
2424    |S| 0.6M 16-bit SCSI-2 System to System Cable
2425    |S| 2.5M 16-bit SCSI-2 System to System Cable
2456    |A| LC-SC 50 Micron Fiber Converter Cable
2459    |A| LC-SC 62.5 Micron Fiber Converter Cable
2591    |A| External USB 1.44 MB Diskette Drive
2640    |A| IDE Slimline DVD-ROM Drive
2709    |S| ARTIC960Hx/RxD 4-Port T1 RJ-45 Cable
2710    |S| ARTIC960Hx/RxD 4-Port E1 RJ-45 Cable
2738    |S| 2 Port USB PCI Adapter
2849    |S| POWER GXT135P Graphics Accelerator with Digital Support
2861    |S| ARTIC960Hx 4-Port EIA-232 Cable
2863    |S| ARTIC960Hx 4-Port X.21 Cable
2864    |S| ARTIC960Hx 4-Port V.35 (DTE) Cable
2871    |S| ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, T1, 100 Ohm, 3M 4-Port Cable
2872    |S| ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, T1, 100 Ohm, 15M Extension Cable
2873    |S| ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, E1, 120 Ohm Balanced, 3M 4-Port
        | |   Cable
2874    |S| ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, E1, 120 Ohm Balanced, 7.5M
        | |   Extension Cable
2877    |S| IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, H.100, 4-Drop Cable
2934    |A| Asynchronous Terminal/Printer Cable EIA-232
2936    |A| Asynchronous Cable EIA-232/V.24
2943    |S| 8-Port Asynchronous Adapter EIA-232/RS-422, PCI bus
2944    |S| 128-Port Asynchronous Controller, PCI bus
2947    |S| IBM ARTIC960Hx 4-Port Multiprotocol PCI Adapter
2951    |S| Cable, V.24 / EIA-232
2952    |S| Cable, V.35
2953    |S| Cable, V.36 / EIA-499
2954    |S| Cable, X.21
2962    |S| 2-Port Multiprotocol PCI Adapter
3124    |A| Serial to Serial Port Cable for Drawer/Drawer
3125    |A| Serial to Serial Port Cable for Rack/Rack
3146    |S| RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 1.2M
3147    |S| RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 3.5M
3148    |S| RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 10M
3156    |A| RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 1.75M
3168    |S| RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 2.5M
3273    |N| 36.4 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
3274    |S| 73.4 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
3275    |S| 146.8 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
3277    |S| 36.4 GB 15,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
3278    |S| 73.4 GB 15,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
3279    |S| 146.8 GB 15,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
3578    |S| 300 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
3636    |S| L200P Flat Panel Monitor
3637    |S| IBM T541H /L150p 15" TFT Color Monitor
3638    |S| IBM C220p 21-inch Color Monitor, Business Black, and  Cable
3639    |S| IBM ThinkVision L170p Flat Panel Monitor
3640    |S| IBM ThinkVision L171p Flat Panel Monitor
3641    |S| IBM T115 Flat Panel Monitor
3642    |S| ThinkVision L191p Flat Panel Monitor
3643    |S| IBM T120 Flat Panel Monitor
3644    |S| IBM T119 Flat Panel Monitor
3645    |S| IBM T117 Flat Panel Monitor
3647    |S| 146GB 15K RPM SAS Disk Drive
3648    |S| 300GB 15K RPM SAS Disk Drive
3649    |S| 450GB 15K RPM SAS Disk Drive
3652    |A| SAS Cable (EE) Drawer to Drawer 1M
3653    |A| SAS Cable (EE) Drawer to Drawer 3M
3654    |A| SAS Cable (EE) Drawer to Drawer 6M
3661    |A| SAS Cable (X) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Dual Controller/
        | |Dual Path 3M
3662    |A| SAS Cable (X) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Dual Controller/
        | |Dual Path 6M
3663    |A| SAS Cable (X) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Dual Controller/
        | |Dual Path 15M
3684    |A| SAS Cable (AE) Adapter to Enclosure, single controller/
        | |single path 3M
3685    |A| SAS Cable (AE) Adapter to Enclosure, single controller/
        | |single path 6M
3691    |A| SAS Cable (YO) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Single Controller/
        | |Dual Path 1.5 M
3692    |A| SAS Cable (YO) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Single Controller/
        | |Dual Path 3 M
3693    |A| SAS Cable (YO) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Single Controller/
        | |Dual Path 6 M
3694    |A| SAS Cable (YO) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Single Controller/
        | |Dual Path 15 M
3752    |S| Service Package
3925    |A| Serial Port Converter Cable, 9-Pin to 25-Pin
3926    |S| Asynch Printer/Terminal Cable, 9-pin to 25-pin, 4M
3927    |A| Serial Port Null Modem Cable, 9-pin to 9-pin, 3.7M
3928    |A| Serial Port Null Modem Cable, 9-pin to 9-pin, 10M
4242    |A| 6 Foot Extender Cable for Displays (15 pin D-shell to 15
        | |      pin D-shell)
4256    |A| Extender Cable - USB Keyboards, 2M
4263    |A| SCSI Cables (Power and Logic), PCI Riser to SCSI LVD Media
        | |      Device; Mounting Tray
4267    |S| SCSI Cable, PCI Adapter to Hot-Swap Disks
4273    |A| External SCSI Port Enablement Cable
4274    |A| SCSI Cable, PCI Adapter to Hot-Swap Disks
4353    |S| H-100 Bus 8-position Cable
4443    |S| 512MB (2x256MB) DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR SDRAM
4444    |S| 1024MB (4x256MB)  DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR SDRAM
4445    |S| 4096MB (4x1024MB) DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR SDRAM
4447    |S| 2048MB (4x512MB)  DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR SDRAM
4449    |S| 8192MB (4x2048MB) DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR Stacked SDRAM
4450    |S| 16GB   (4x4096MB) DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR Stacked SDRAM
4650    |A| Rack Indicator- Not Factory Integrated
4651    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #1
4652    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #2
4653    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #3
4654    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #4
4655    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #5
4656    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #6
4657    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #7
4658    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #8
4659    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #9
4660    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #10
4661    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #11
4662    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #12
4663    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #13
4664    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #14
4665    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #15
4666    |A| Rack Indicator, Rack #16
4691    |S| Rack Status Beacon Cable, Junction Box To Drawer Or Status
        | |      Beacon
4692    |S| Rack Status Beacon Cable, Junction Box Daisy Chain
4693    |S| Rack Status Beacon Junction Box
4764    |S| PCI-X Cryptographic Coprocessor (FIPS 4)
4959    |S| IBM Token-Ring PCI Adapter
4962    |S| 10/100 Mbps Ethernet PCI Adapter II
5001    |S| Customer Service Specify
5005    |A| Software Preinstall
5237    |S| 2-way 1.65 GHz POWER5 CUoD Processor Card, 0-Way Active, 8
        | |      Memory DIMM Slots
5239    |S| 1-way 1.5 GHz POWER5 Processor Card, No L3 Cache
5264    |S| 2-way 1.5 GHz POWER5 Processor Card, 36MB L3 Cache, DDR 1
        | |      Memory DIMMs
5700    |A| IBM Gigabit Ethernet-SX PCI-X Adapter
5701    |A| IBM 10/100/1000 Base-TX Ethernet PCI-X Adapter
5703    |S| PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter
5706    |A| IBM 2-Port 10/100/1000 Base-TX Ethernet PCI-X Adapter
5707    |A| IBM 2-Port Gigabit Ethernet-SX PCI-X Adapter
5709    |S| Dual Channel SCSI RAID Enablement Card
5712    |S| PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter
5713    |A| 1 Gigabit iSCSI TOE PCI-X on Copper Media Adapter
5714    |A| 1 Gigabit iSCSI TOE PCI-X on Optical Media Adapter
5716    |S| 2 Gigabit Fibre Channel PCI-X Adapter
5718    |S| 10 Gigabit Ethernet PCI-X Adapter
5719    |S| IBM 10 Gigabit Ethernet-LR PCI-X Adapter
5721    |S| 10 Gb Ethernet-SR PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter
5722    |S| 10 Gb Ethernet-LR PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter
5723    |S| 2-Port Asynchronous EIA-232 PCI Adapter
5736    |S| PCI-X DDR Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter
5727    |S| Dual Channel SCSI RAID Enablement Card
5737    |S| PCI-X DDR Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter
5740    |S| 4-Port 10/100/1000 Base-TX PCI-X Adapter
5751    |A| IBM 4.7 GB IDE Slimline DVD-RAM Drive
5755    |S| 200/400GB Half High Ultrium 2 Tape Drive
5758    |A| 4 Gb Single-Port Fibre Channel PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter
5759    |S| 4 Gb Dual-Port Fibre Channel PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter
5886    |S| EXP 12S Expansion Drawer
5902    |S| PCI-X DDR Dual - x4 3Gb SAS RAID Adapter
5912    |S| PCI-X DDR Dual - x4 SAS Adapter
5922    |A| Non-paired SAS RAID indicator
5951    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, US English, #103P
5952    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, French, #189
5953    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Italian, #142
5954    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, German/Austrian, #129
5955    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, UK English, #166P
5956    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Spanish, #172
5957    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Japanese, #194
5958    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Brazilian
        | | Portuguese, #275
5959    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Hungarian, #208
5960    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Korean, #413
5961    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Chinese, #467
5962    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, French Canadian, #445
5963    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Canadian French, #058
5964    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Belgian/French, #120
5965    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Swedish/Finnish, #153
5966    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Danish, #159
5967    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Bulgarian, #442
5968    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Swiss/French/
        | | German, #150
5969    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Norwegian,#155
5970    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Dutch, #143
5971    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Portuguese, #163
5972    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Greek, #319
5973    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Hebrew, #212
5974    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Polish, #214
5975    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Slovakian, #245
5976    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Czech, #243
5977    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Turkish, #179
5978    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, LA Spanish, #171
5979    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Arabic, #253
5980    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Thai, #191
5981    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Russian, #443
5982    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Slovenian, #234
5983    |S| Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, US English
        | | International, #103P
6001    |S| Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 2 meter
6006    |A| Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 3 meter
6007    |A| Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 15 meter
6008    |A| Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 6 meter
6029    |A| Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 30 meter
6120    |S| IBM 80/160 GB Internal Tape Drive with VXA Technology
6134    |S| 60/150 GB 16-bit 8mm Internal Tape Drive
6204    |S| PCI Universal Differential Ultra SCSI Adapter
6230    |S| Advanced SerialRAID Plus Adapter
6231    |S| 128 MByte DRAM Option Card
6235    |S| 32 MByte Fast-Write Cache Option Card
6258    |A| 36/72GB 4mm Internal Tape Drive
6271    |S| LTO Ultrium 200GB Data Cartridge
6279    |A| VXA-320 160/320GB Internal Tape Drive
6310    |S| IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad Digital Trunk PCI Adapter
6312    |S| Quad Digital Trunk Telephony PCI Adapter
6458    |A| Power Cable -- Drawer to IBM PDU, 14-foot, 250V/10A
6460    |A| Power Cord (14-foot), Drawer to OEM PDU (125V, 15A),
        | | Plug Type #4
6469    |A| Power Cord (14-foot), Drawer to OEM PDU (250V, 15A),
        | | United States, Plug Type #5
6470    |A| Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall (125V, 15A), Plug Type #4
6471    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (125V, 15A), Plug
        | |      Type #70
6472    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 16A), Plug
        | |      Type #18
6473    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 10A), Plug
        | |      Type 19
6474    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 13A), Plug
        | |      Type #23
6475    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 16A), Plug
        | |      Type #32
6476    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 10A), Plug
        | |      Type #24
6477    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 16A), Plug
        | |      Type #22
6478    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 16A), Plug
        | |      Type #25
6479    |S| Power Cord (9-foot) , To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 10A), Plug
        | |      Type #6
6487    |S| Power Cord (6-foot) ,To Wall,  (250V, 15A), United States,
        | |      Plug Type #5
6488    |A| Power Cord (9-foot) , To Wall/OEM PDU,  (125V, 15A or 250V,
        | |      10A), Plug Type #2
6493    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 10A), Plug
        | |      Type #62
6494    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 10A), Plug
        | |      Type #69
6495    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 10A), Plug
        | |      Type #64
6496    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 10A), Plug
        | |      Type #66
6497    |S| Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 15A), Plug
        | |      Type #10
6498    |S| Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 15A), Plug
        | |      Type #34
6592    |S| Ultra320 SCSI 4-Pack
6593    |S| Ultra320 SCSI 4-Pack for Disk Mirroring
6598    |A| Disk Slot Fillers (Quantity 4)
6651    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (125V, 15A), Plug
        | |      Type #75
6659    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 15A), Plug
        | |      Type #76
6660    |A| Power Cord (14-foot), Drawer To OEM PDU (125V, 15A), Plug
        | |      Type #59 (DENAN marking)
6669    |A| Power Cord (14-foot), Drawer to OEM PDU,  (250V, 15A),
        | |      Plug Type #57 (DENAN marking)
6670    |A| Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall (125V, 15A), Plug Type #59
        | |      (DENAN marking)
6671    |A| Power Cord (9-foot), Drawer to IBM PDU,  250V/10A
6672    |A| Power Cord 2M (6.5-foot), Drawer to IBM PDU, 250V/10A
6680    |A| Power Cord (9-foot) , To Wall/OEM PDU,  (250V, 10A), Plug
        | |      Type #6, Insulated
6687    |A| Power Cord (6-foot),To Wall,  (250V, 15A), Plug Type #57
        | |      (DENAN marking)
7162    |A| IBM/OEM Rack-mount Drawer Rail Kit
7163    |S| OEM Rack-mount Drawer Rail Kit
7305    |A| AAP Software Pre-Install Indicator
7549    |S| Quantity 150 of #3647
7564    |S| Quantity 150 of #3648
7565    |S| Quantity 150 of #3649
7601    |S| One Processor Entitlement for Processor Feature #5239
7603    |S| One Processor Activation for Processor Feature #5264
7801    |A| Ethernet Cable, 6M, Hardware Management Console to System
        | |      Unit
7802    |A| Ethernet Cable, 15M, Hardware Management Console to System
        | |      Unit
7871    |S| One Processor Activation for CUoD Processor Feature #5237
7876    |A| Processor Power Regulator
7877    |S| Media Backplane
7886    |A| IBM Rack-mount Drawer Bezel and Hardware
7887    |A| IBM Deskside Cover Set
7889    |A| Power Supply, 1475 watt AC, Hot-swap, Base and Redundant
7930    |A| On/Off Processor Enablement for CoD
7931    |A| On/Off Processor Billing for CoD
7934    |A| 30 Days Prepaid Reserve Capacity for CoD
7941    |A| Advanced POWER Virtualization
8131    |S| 128-Port Asynchronous Controller Cable, 4.5 Meter
8132    |S| 128-Port Asynchronous Controller Cable, 23cm (9-Inch)
8133    |S| RJ-45 to DB-25 Converter Cable
8136    |S| Rack Mountable Remote Asynchronous Node 16-Port EIA-232
8137    |S| Enhanced Remote Asynchronous Node 16-Port EIA-232
8450    |S| Zero-priced Value Pak Processor Activation Code for #5237
8463    |S| Zero-priced Value Pak Processor Entitlement for #5239
8465    |S| Zero-priced Value Pak Processor Activation Code for #5264
8800    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, US English, #103P
8801    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, French, #189
8802    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Italian, #142
8803    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black,
        | |      German/Austrian, #129
8804    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, UK English, #166
8805    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Spanish, #172
8806    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Japanese, #194
8807    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black,
        | |      Brazilian/Portuguese, #275
8808    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Canadian
        | |      French, #058
8810    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Belgian/Dutch,
        | |      #120
8811    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black,
        | |      Swedish/Finnish, #153
8812    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Danish, #159
8813    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Bulgarian, #442
8814    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black,
        | |      Swiss/French/German, #150F/G
8816    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Norwegian, #155
8817    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Dutch, #143
8818    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Portuguese, #163
8819    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Greek, #319
8820    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Hebrew, #212
8821    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Hungarian, #208
8823    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Polish, #214
8825    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Slovakian, #245
8826    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Czech, #243
8827    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Turkish, #179
8829    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, LA Spanish, #171
8830    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Arabic, #238
8833    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Korean, #413
8834    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Chinese/US, #467
8835    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, French
        | |      Canadian, #445
8836    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Thai, #191
8838    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Russian, #443
8839    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black,
        | |      Yugoslavian/Latin, #105
8840    |S| Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, US English
        | |      (EMEA), #103P
8841    |S| Mouse - Business Black with Keyboard Attachment Cable
8845    |A| USB Mouse
9004    |A| Southern Hemisphere Designator for Monitors
9169    |A| Order Routing Indicator - System Plant
9300    |A| Language Group Specify - US English
9700    |A| Language Group Specify - Dutch
9703    |A| Language Group Specify - French
9704    |A| Language Group Specify - German
9705    |A| Language Group Specify - Polish
9707    |A| Language Group Specify - Portuguese
9708    |A| Language Group Specify - Spanish
9711    |A| Language Group Specify - Italian
9712    |A| Language Group Specify - Canadian French
9714    |A| Language Group Specify - Japanese
9715    |A| Language Group Specify - Traditional Chinese (Taiwan)
9716    |A| Language Group Specify - Korean
9718    |A| Language Group Specify - Turkish
9719    |A| Language Group Specify - Hungarian
9720    |A| Language Group Specify - Slovakian
9721    |A| Language Group Specify - Russian
9722    |A| Language Group Specify - Simplified Chinese (PRC)
9724    |A| Language Group Specify - Czech
9725    |A| Language Group Specify -- Romanian
9727    |A| Language Group Specify -- Slovenian
 

Model conversions

None.
Back to topBack to top
 

Technical description
TOC Link Physical specifications TOC Link Operating environment TOC Link Limitations
TOC Link Hardware requirements TOC Link Software requirements


Physical specifications

  • Deskside/Desktop:
    • Width: 201 mm (07.9 in)
    • Depth: 779 mm (30.7 in)
    • Weight: 533 mm (21.1 in)

  • Rack - Mount:

    • Width: 437 mm (17.2 in)

    • Depth: 686 mm (27.0 in)

    • Height: 178 mm (07.0 in)

    • Weight:
      • Minimum configuration: 41.4 Kg (91 lb)
      • Maximum configuration: 57.0 Kg (125 lb)

Operating environment

  • Temperature: (Nonoperating) 5 to 45 degrees C (41 to 113 F)

    Note: Recommended temperature (Operating) 5 to 35 degrees C (41 to 95 F).

  • Relative humidity: 8 % to 80 %

  • Maximum wet bulb: (Power Off) 27 degrees C (80 F)

  • Operating voltage: 1-to 2-way 100 to 127 or 200 to 240 V ac (auto-ranging)

    Note: Operating voltage: 4-way 200 to 240 V ac.

  • Operating frequency: 47/63 Hz

  • Power consumption: 1100 watts (maximum)

  • Thermal output: 3,754 Btu/hour (maximum)

  • Power source loading:
    • 1.158 kVA (maximum configuration)
    • Maximum altitude: 3,048 m (10,000 ft)

Noise Level and Sound Power

  • Sound Power: Model 550 rack-mount -- 6.0 Bels Idle/6.0 Bels Operating
  • Sound Power: Model 550 deskside -- 6.6 Bels Idle/6.8 Bels Operating

EMC Conformance Classification

This equipment is subject to FCC rules and shall comply with the appropriate FCC rules before final delivery to the buyer or centers of distribution.

  • U.S.A.:
    • FCC Class A for Deskside/Desktop;
    • FCC Class A for Rack Mount

  • Europe:
    • CISPR 22 Class A for Deskside/Desktop;
    • CISPR 22 Class A for Rack Mount

  • Japan:
    • VCCI-A for Deskside/Desktop;
    • VCCI-A for Rack Mount

  • Korea:
    • Korean Requirement Class A for Deskside/Desktop;
    • Class A Rack Mount

  • China: People's Republic of China commodity inspection law

Homologation -- Telecom Environmental Testing (Safety and EMC)

Homologation approval for specific countries has been initiated with the IBM Homologation and Type Approval (HT&A) organization in LaGaude. This IBM pSeries model and applicable features meet the environmental testing requirements of the country TELECOM and have been designed and tested in compliance with the Full Quality Assurance Approval (FQAA) process as delivered by the British Approval Board for Telecom (BABT), the U.K. Telecom regulatory authority.

Product safety/country testing/certification

  • UL 60950-1 First Edition 1950 Underwriters Laboratory, Safety Information

  • CSA C22.2 No. 60950-1-03 First Edition

  • EN60950 European Norm

  • IEC 60950-1, Edition 1, and 60950 Third Edition International Electrotechnical Commission, Safety Information

  • Nordic deviations to IEC-950 1st Edition, as outlined in document EMKO-TSE(05-SEC) 200/93

General Requirements

The product is in compliance with IBM Corporate Bulletin C-B 0-2594-000 Statement of Conformity of IBM Product to External Standard (Suppliers Declaration).

Limitations

System

  • External SCSI Port Enablement Cable:

    • When feature number 4273 is installed in the system, a second 4-pack disk enclosure (second #6592 or first #6593) cannot be installed.

    • The system ports are similar to serial ports, however they are disabled when either HMC port is connected to a Hardware Management Console. Either the HMC ports or the system ports can be used, but not both.

      Even when no HMC is attached, integrated system ports will work properly only with modems, async terminals, and certain UPSs for which the manufacturer provides a special cable. Attachment of any other serial devices (including system-to-system connections for HACMP) requires a serial port adapter in a PCI slot.

    • One PCI-X slot is required.

    • The maximum external cable length supported by #4273 is 6 meters.

Processor cards

  • A minimum of one processor on one processor card is required on an order with a maximum of four processors on two processor cards.

  • One 1-way processor card (#5239), or one/two 2-way processor cards (#5264/#5237) may be installed in a system".

    • 1-way POWER5 1.5 GHz processor card (#5239) must be entitled (1 x #7601 or 1 x #8463)

    • 2-way POWER5 1.5 GHz processor card (#5264) requires that at least one processor activation code (#7603) be ordered. A maximum of two processor activation code features (2 x #7603, or 1 x #7603 and 1 x #8645) are allowed per processor card.

    • 2-way POWER5 1.65 GHz processor card (#5237) requires that at least one processor activation feature (#7871) must be ordered. A maximum of two processor activation features (2 x #7871, or 1 x #7871 and 1 x #8450) are allowed per processor card.

  • Each processor card contains 32 KB of data cache and 64 KB of instruction cache.

  • Each processor card contains 1.9 MB of Level 2 cache.

Power supply

  • The base machine contains one ac power supply with a second available for redundancy.

Redundant power supply/Fans

  • Second optional AC (#7889) power supply.
  • Redundant fans standard.

Dynamic logical partitioning

  • This function is supported by AIX and the Linux 2.6 kernel which is currently available only in SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER.

Power cords

  • On a 4-way p5-550 system (2 x # 5237), a 220V power cord is required. Cannot use feature #6460, #6470, #6471, or #6488

System memory

  • A maximum of 64 GB of system memory available with two processor cards installed in the system.

  • Eight memory DIMM slots are on a processor card. Maximum system memory with one processor card is 32 GB.

  • A minimum of 512 MB of memory is required.

  • Memory DIMMs #4443 must be ordered and installed in pairs

  • Memory DIMMs (#4444, #4445, #4447, #4449, and #4450) must be ordered and installed in quads

  • Memory feature numbers may be mixed within a system.

Figure 1. Memory features

                     Feature     Minimum    Maximum
Feature              number      quantity   quantity
-------------------- ------      --------   --------
512 MB                4443          0          2
  (2 x 256 MB DIMMs)
 
1024 MB               4444          0          4
  (4 x 256 MB DIMMs)
 
2048 MB               4447          0          4
  (4 x 512 MB DIMMs)
 
4096 MB               4445          0          4
  (4 x 1024 MB DIMMs)
 
8192 MB               4449          0          4
  (4 x 2048 MB DIMMs)
 
16384 MB              4450          0          4
  (4 x 4096 MB DIMMs)
 

I/O Drawers

Model 550 systems can be attached to 7311-D20 I/O drawers using the standard RIO-2 ports and/or the optional Dual Port RIO-2 I/O Hub (#1806).

  • Maximum of eight drawers per system
  • Maximum of two RIO loops

PCI card slots

The model 550 has a maximum of five hot-plug PCI-X slots:

  • Slots 1 to 4 are long, 64-bit, 3.3 V, and run at 133 MHz.

  • Slot 5 is physically shared by either a PCI-X adapter or the Dual Port RIO-2 I/O Hub (#1806). The PCI-X adapter installed in slot 5 must be a short card.

Graphics adapters

  • Graphics adapter, keyboard, and mouse are not required in the minimum configuration.
  • The maximum number of graphics adapters supported in the model 550 is two.

I/O adapters

  • Feature number 5709 is not plugged into a slot.
  • Refer to Figure 2 for additional I/O adapter limitations. Feature #1806 requires that two processor cards be installed in the system
  • Adapter installed in slot 5 must be short.
  • Feature number 5718 requires that 2 processor cards be installed in the system.

Figure 2. I/O adapter features

                            Feature Max
I/O Adapter                 number  qty                   Size
--------------------        ------- ---                   -----
 2-port USB PCI              2738     2                   Short
 8-Port Async                2943     2                   Short
 128-Port Async              2944     2                   Short
 Artic960 Hx 4-ports         2947     4                   Long
 2-Port Multiprotocol        2962     4                   Short
 GXT135P Graphics
 Accelerator                 2849     2                   Short
 4/16 Token Ring             4959     4                   Short
 10/100 Ethernet             4962     5                   Short
 Gigabit Ethernet            5700     5                   Short
 10/100/1000 Ethernet        5701     5                   Short
 PCI-X Ultra320 SCSI RAID    5703     4                   Long
 2-port 10/100/1000 Ether.   5706     5                   Short
 2-port Gigabit Ether.-SX    5707     5                   Short
 SCSI RAID Enablement Card   5709     1                   N/A
 PCI-X Ultra320 SCSI         5712     5                   Short
 Ultra SCSI Differential     6204     2                   Short
 Quad Digital Trunk          6312     4                   Long
 2 Gb Fibre Channel PCI-X    5716     5                   Short
 10 Gigabit Ethernet PCI-X   5718     1                   Short
 

Storage devices/bays

  • The 550 has two DASD 4-packs in the system, one mandatory (#6592) and one optional (#6592 or #6593).

  • Media bays can contain an optional DVD-ROM (#2640 or follow-on) in bays 2 and 3, an optional DVD-RAM (#5751 or follow-on) in bays 2 and 3, and an optional tape drive (#5755, #6120, #6134, #6258, or follow-ons) in bay 4.

  • Either a DVD-ROM (#2640) or DVD-RAM (#5751) must be selected

  • If optional tape drive feature number 5755, 6120, 6134, 6258, or 6279 is installed, cable feature number 4263 is required. Cable feature number 4263 requires 5755, 6120, 6134, 6258, or 6279 to be installed.

  • The first optical device can only be installed in the top slimline bay in the rack configuration.

  • Note that 1722-6LU (TotalStorage DS4300 Midrange Disk System) is only supported under Linux Operating System.

Figure 3. Storage device features

                           Maximum                      Feature
Device                     quantity     Bay             number
------------------------   --------     ---------       -------
DVD-ROM (IDE)                  2        Media 2/3       2640
 
DVD-RAM (IDE)                  2        Media 2/3       5751
 
200/400 GB Tape (LVD)          1        Media 4         5755
 
4-mm 36/72 GB Tape (LVD)       1        Media 4         6258
 
VXA-320 160/320GB Internal
  Tape Drive                   1        Media 4         6279
 
8-mm 60/150 GB Tape (LVD)      1        Media 4         6134
 
8-mm 80/160 GB Tape (LVD)      1        Media 4         6120
 
36.4 GB 10,000 rpm             8        DASD 1-8        3273
Ultra320 SCSI Disk,
Hot-swap
 
36.4 GB 15,000 rpm Ultra320
SCSI Disk, Hot-swap            8        DASD 1-8        3277
 
73.4 GB 10,00 rpm              8        DASD 1-8        3274
Ultra320 SCSI Disk,
Hot-swap
 
73.4 GB 15,000 rpm             8        DASD 1-8        3278
Ultra320 SCSI Disk, Hot-swap
 
146.8 GB 10,00 rpm,            8        DASD 1-8        3275
Ultra320 SCSI Disk, Hot-swap
 
Ultra320 SCSI 4-pack           2        System Planar   6592
 
Ultra320 SCSI 4-pack for       1        System Planar   6593
disk mirroring
 

Linux operating system

For customers installing SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later, or Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS for POWER Version 3, refer to the following Web site for information on supported I/O adapters and storage devices:

http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
hardware/factsfeatures.html
 

Hardware requirements

Model 550 minimum system configuration

The model 550 server can be configured to incorporate up to two 2-way processors, 64 GB of system memory, five PCI adapters, and multiple media devices, as desired. This flexibility is made available through the many optional features for the model 550.

Each model 550 must include a minimum of the following items:

  • One system Central Electronics Complex (CEC) enclosure with the following items:
    • One power cord (#6458, #6460, #6469-#6479, #6487, #6488, #6493-#6498)
    • One language group, Specify (#9300 or #97xx)

  • One processor power regulator (#7876)

  • One or two processor entitlements or activations:
    • 1 x #7601 with processsor card #5239
    • 2 x #7603, or 1 x #7603 and 1 x #8465 with processsor card #5264
    • 2 x #7871, or 1 x #7871 and 1 x #8450 with processsor card #5237
    • 1.5 GHz, No L3 Cache (#5239)

  • One processor card
    • POWER5 processor -- 1-way 1.5 GHz, No L3 Cache (#5239)
    • POWER5 processor -- 2-way 1.5 GHz, 36 MB L3 Cache (#5264)
    • POWER5 processor -- 2-way 1.65 GHz, 36MB L3 Cache (#5237)

  • Choose 512 MB minimum memory from:
    • 512 MB Memory (2 x 256 MB DIMMs) (#4443)
    • 1024 MB Memory (4 x 256 MB DIMMs) (#4444)
    • 2048 MB Memory (4 x 512 MB DIMMs) (#4447)
    • 4096 MB Memory (4 x 1024 MB DIMMs) (#4445)
    • 8192 MB Memory (4 x 2048 MB DIMMs) (#4449)
    • 16384 MB Memory (4 x 4096 MB DIMMs) (#4450)

  • Choose disk drive from:
    • 36.4 GB Ultra320 10K rpm (#3273)
    • 36.4 GB Ultra320 15K rpm (#3277)
    • 73.4 GB Ultra320 10K rpm (#3274)
    • 73.4 GB Ultra320 15K rpm (#3278)
    • 146.8 GB Ultra320 10K rpm (#3275)

  • Choose media devices from:
    • DVD-ROM (#2640)
    • DVD-RAM (#5751)

  • One 4-pack disk drive enclosure (#6592)

  • One Power supply, 1475 watt AC, Hot-swap, Base (#7889)

  • One Media Backplane Card (#7877)

  • Configuration indicator:
    • #7887 for deskside system with IBM cover set
    • #7886 for rack-mount system with IBM bezel
    • #7162 for rack-mount system with IBM/OEM rack mounting rails
    • #7163 for rack-mount system with OEM rack mounting rails

    Note: If feature number 7886 is selected, either feature number 7162 or 7163 must be selected.

p5 Model 550 HA solution configuration - Rack configuration

The model 550 HA solution package must include a minimum of the following hardware and software that must be ordered together as specified:

Two model 550 servers, each incorporating:

  • Minimum model 550 configuration:

    • One 1-way (#5239) processor

    • One processor power regulator (#7876)

    • One processor entitlement (1 x #7601)

    • One 512 MB memory DIMM (#4443)

    • One 36.4 GB disk drive (#3273)

    • One 4-pack disk drive enclosure (#6592)

    • One DVD-ROM (#2640) or DVD-RAM (#5751)

    • One Power supply, 1475 watt AC, Hot-swap, Base (#7889)

    • One Media Backplane Card (#7877)

    • Two configuration Indicators (#7886 for IBM bezel; #7162 for IBM/OEM rack mounting rails or #7163 for OEM rack mounting rails)

    • One power cord (#6458, #6460, #6469-#6479, #6487, #6488, #6493-#6498)

    • One language group specify (#9300 or #97xx)

  • Two SCSI adapters or one SCSI adapter and #4273

  • Two LAN adapters (One integrated Ethernet port may be used)

  • One redundant CEC AC Power Supply (#7889)

  • One Asynchronous Adapter (#2943/#2944)

  • One Serial-to-Serial Port Cable for Drawer/Drawer (#3124/#3125)

Note: Only one serial cable (#3124/#3125) is needed for the two model 550 systems. Redundant dedicated heartbeat and messaging paths are required via LAN and asynch ports on each server.

  • One AIX 5L V5.2 or AIX V5.3, or later, license

  • One HACMP license:
    • HACMP V5.2

      Note: HACMP V5 support of these boxes on AIX 5.3, when available, will be detailed and updated in the HACMP V5 (5765-F62) Sales Manual.

  • One 7014-T00 or 7014-T42 System Rack, including:
    • Two Rack Content Specify: 9113-550 (#0230)
    • One Rack Content Specify: 2104-DS4 (#0204)
    • One Power Distribution Unit, Side Mount (#6171, #6173, or #6174)

Note: Additional optional 7014-T00 or 7014-T42 features can be added.

  • One 2104-DS4 Expandable Storage Plus, including:
    • Four disk drives
    • One or two Ultra320 cables
    • One Rochester Manufacturing Integration (#0987) or Dublin Manufacturing Integration (#0970)

Note: Additional optional 2104-DS4 features can be added.

RAID

Internal RAID is available on the model 550. A number of options are available to customers wanting to install RAID on their systems:

  1. Install feature number 5709, the Dual Channel SCSI RAID Enablement Card. Install four disk drives in feature number 6592, the Ultra320 SCSI 4-pack enclosure. This will allow RAID capabilities within a single 4-pack of DASD.

  2. Install feature number 5709. Install a second feature number 6592. This will allow RAID capabilities across two 4-packs of DASD.

  3. Install feature number 5709. Install feature number 6593, the Ultra320 SCSI 4-Pack Enclosure for Disk Mirroring. Install feature number 5703, the PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter. Install feature number 4267 or 4274, the SCSI Cable which connects the PCI Adapter to feature number 6593.

Software requirements

If installing AIX on the system (one of these):

  • AIX Version 5L for POWER V5.2 with the 5200-04 Recommended Maintenance Package (APAR IY56722), or later

    Note: Advanced POWER Virtualization feature (#7941) is not supported on AIX 5L for POWER V5.2

or

  • AIX 5L for POWER V5.3, or later

If installing Linux on the system (one of these):

  • SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later

  • Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS for POWER Version 3 (Planned Availability Date: September 30, 2004)

    Note: Not all p5-550 system features available under the AIX operating system are available under the Linux operating system.

Information on features and external devices supported by Linux on the model 550 can be found at:

http://www-1.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/linux

If installing the model 550 server within the Cluster 1600:

  • CSM V1.4 (AIX or LINUX)

Back to topBack to top
 
Publications

The following information will be shipped with the 9113-550. Additional copies are available. To order, contact your IBM representative.

                Title                                     Order Number
----------------------------------------------            ------------
IBM eServer Hardware Information Center CD-ROM             SK3T-8159
IBM eServer Safety Information                             G229-9054
Start Here for IBM eServer                                 SA41-5156
IBM Statement of Limited Warranty                          Z125-4753
IBM License Agreement for Machine Code                     Z125-5468
Pointer Sheet for Machine Internal Code License Agreement  GC52-1065
 

Hardware books such as installation guides, user's guides, and service guides are available to download or view at:

http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/library/hardware_docs

AIX documentation can be found at:

http://www.ibm.com/servers/aix/library/techpubs.html

The Publication Notification System (PNS) is available by order number/ product number. Customers currently subscribing to PNS will automatically receive notifications by e-mail. Customers who want to subscribe, to the PNS Web site location at:

http://service5.boulder.ibm.com/pnsrege.nsf/WebMessages/WelcomeENUS

The publications listed on the notification can be ordered by calling the Publication Support Group in Raleigh at 800-879-2755, option 1. The IBM Publications Center Portal:

http://www.ibm.com/shop/publications/order

The Publications Center is a worldwide central repository for IBM product publications and marketing material with a catalog of 70,000 items. Extensive search facilities are provided, as well as payment options via credit card. Furthermore, a large number of publications are available online in various file formats, which can currently be downloaded free of charge.

Note: PNS subscribers most often order their publications via the Publication Center.
Back to topBack to top
 

Features
TOC Link Features - No charge TOC Link Features - Chargeable TOC Link Feature descriptions
TOC Link Feature exchanges


Features - No charge

  • CABLES
    • (#3652) - SAS Cable (EE) Drawer to Drawer 1M
    • (#3653) - SAS Cable (EE) Drawer to Drawer 3M
    • (#3654) - SAS Cable (EE) Drawer to Drawer 6M
    • (#3661) - SAS Cable (X) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Dual Controller/ Dual Path 3M
    • (#3662) - SAS Cable (X) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Dual Controller/ Dual Path 6M
    • (#3663) - SAS Cable (X) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Dual Controller/ Dual Path 15M
    • (#3684) - SAS Cable (AE) Adapter to Enclosure, single controller/ single path 3M
    • (#3685) - SAS Cable (AE) Adapter to Enclosure, single controller/ single path 6M
    • (#3691) - SAS Cable (YO) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Single Controller/Dual Path 1.5 M
    • (#3692) - SAS Cable (YO) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Single Controller/Dual Path 3 M
    • (#3693) - SAS Cable (YO) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Single Controller/Dual Path 6 M
    • (#3694) - SAS Cable (YO) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Single Controller/Dual Path 15 M
    • (#6001) - Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 2 meter
    • (#6007) - Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 15 meter
    • (#6008) - Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 6 meter

  • LANGUAGES
    • (#9300) - Language Group Specify - US English
    • (#9700) - Language Group Specify - Dutch
    • (#9703) - Language Group Specify - French
    • (#9704) - Language Group Specify - German
    • (#9705) - Language Group Specify - Polish
    • (#9707) - Language Group Specify - Portuguese
    • (#9708) - Language Group Specify - Spanish
    • (#9711) - Language Group Specify - Italian
    • (#9712) - Language Group Specify - Canadian French
    • (#9714) - Language Group Specify - Japanese
    • (#9715) - Language Group Specify - Traditional Chinese (Taiwan)
    • (#9716) - Language Group Specify - Korean
    • (#9718) - Language Group Specify - Turkish
    • (#9719) - Language Group Specify - Hungarian
    • (#9720) - Language Group Specify - Slovakian
    • (#9721) - Language Group Specify - Russian
    • (#9722) - Language Group Specify - Simplified Chinese (PRC)
    • (#9724) - Language Group Specify - Czech
    • (#9725) - Language Group Specify - Romanian
    • (#9727) - Language Group Specify - Slovenian

  • MISCELLANEOUS
    • (#0050) - IBM Express Seller Indicator
    • (#0986) - CCS Customer Service Specify (US)
    • (#5001) - Customer Service Specify
    • (#7305) - AAP Software Pre-Install Indicator
    • (#7941) - Advanced POWER Virtualization

  • SPECIFY CODES
    • (#0265) - AIX Partition Specify
    • (#0266) - Linux Partition Specify
    • (#4650) - Rack Indicator- Not Factory Integrated
    • (#4651) - Rack Indicator, Rack #1
    • (#4652) - Rack Indicator, Rack #2
    • (#4653) - Rack Indicator, Rack #3
    • (#4654) - Rack Indicator, Rack #4
    • (#4655) - Rack Indicator, Rack #5
    • (#4656) - Rack Indicator, Rack #6
    • (#4657) - Rack Indicator, Rack #7
    • (#4658) - Rack Indicator, Rack #8
    • (#4659) - Rack Indicator, Rack #9
    • (#4660) - Rack Indicator, Rack #10
    • (#4661) - Rack Indicator, Rack #11
    • (#4662) - Rack Indicator, Rack #12
    • (#4663) - Rack Indicator, Rack #13
    • (#4664) - Rack Indicator, Rack #14
    • (#4665) - Rack Indicator, Rack #15
    • (#4666) - Rack Indicator, Rack #16
    • (#9004) - Southern Hemisphere Designator for Monitors
    • (#9169) - Order Routing Indicator - System Plant

Features - Chargeable

Special Features - Initial Orders

  • ADMINISTRATIVE
    • (#0983) - US TAA Compliance Indicator

  • MISCELLANEOUS
    • (#5005) - Software Preinstall

Special Features - Plant and/or Field Installable

  • ADAPTERS
    • (#1806) - Dual Port RIO-2 I/O Hub
    • (#1809) - GX Dual-port 4x IB HCA
    • (#1820) - PCI-X Dual-port 4x IB HCA
    • (#2738) - 2 Port USB PCI Adapter
    • (#2849) - POWER GXT135P Graphics Accelerator with Digital Support
    • (#2943) - 8-Port Asynchronous Adapter EIA-232/RS-422, PCI bus
    • (#2944) - 128-Port Asynchronous Controller, PCI bus
    • (#2947) - IBM ARTIC960Hx 4-Port Multiprotocol PCI Adapter
    • (#2962) - 2-Port Multiprotocol PCI Adapter
    • (#4764) -PCI-X Cryptographic Coprocessor (FIPS 4)
    • (#4959) - IBM Token-Ring PCI Adapter
    • (#4962) - 10/100 Mbps Ethernet PCI Adapter II
    • (#5700) - IBM Gigabit Ethernet-SX PCI-X Adapter
    • (#5701) - IBM 10/100/1000 Base-TX Ethernet PCI-X Adapter
    • (#5706) - IBM 2-Port 10/100/1000 Base-TX Ethernet PCI-X Adapter
    • (#5707) - IBM 2-Port Gigabit Ethernet-SX PCI-X Adapter
    • (#5703) - PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter
    • (#5709) - Dual Channel SCSI RAID Enablement Card
    • (#5712) - PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter
    • (#5713) - 1 Gigabit iSCSI TOE PCI-X on Copper Media Adapter
    • (#5714) - 1 Gigabit iSCSI TOE PCI-X on Optical Media Adapter
    • (#5716) - 2 Gigabit Fibre Channel PCI-X Adapter
    • (#5718) - 10 Gigabit Ethernet PCI-X Adapter
    • (#5719) - IBM 10 Gigabit Ethernet-LR PCI-X Adapter
    • (#5721) - 10 Gb Ethernet-SR PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter
    • (#5722) - 10 Gb Ethernet-LR PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter
    • (#5723) - 2-Port Asynchronous EIA-232 PCI Adapter
    • (#5736) - PCI-X DDR Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter
    • (#5727) - Dual Channel SCSI RAID Enablement Card
    • (#5737) - PCI-X DDR Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter
    • (#5740) - 4-Port 10/100/1000 Base-TX PCI-X Adapter
    • (#5758) - 4 Gb Single-Port Fibre Channel PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter
    • (#5759) - 4 Gb Dual-Port Fibre Channel PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter
    • (#5902) - PCI-X DDR Dual - x4 3Gb SAS RAID Adapter
    • (#5912) - PCI-X DDR Dual - x4 SAS Adapter
    • (#5922) - Non-paired SAS RAID indicator
    • (#6204) - PCI Universal Differential Ultra SCSI Adapter
    • (#6230) - Advanced SerialRAID Plus Adapter
    • (#6231) - 128 MByte DRAM Option Card
    • (#6235) - 32 MByte Fast-Write Cache Option Card
    • (#6310) - IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad Digital Trunk PCI Adapter
    • (#6312) - Quad Digital Trunk Telephony PCI Adapter

  • CABLES
    • (#1835) - 3 meter 4x IB Cable
    • (#1836) - 8 meter 4x IB Cable
    • (#1839) - 1.5 meter 4x Cable
    • (#2709) - ARTIC960Hx/RxD 4-Port T1 RJ-45 Cable
    • (#2710) - ARTIC960Hx/RxD 4-Port E1 RJ-45 Cable
    • (#2871) - ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, T1, 100 Ohm, 3M 4-Port Cable
    • (#2872) - ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, T1, 100 Ohm, 15M Extension Cable
    • (#2873) - ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, E1, 120 Ohm Balanced, 3M 4-Port Cable
    • (#2874) - ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, E1, 120 Ohm Balanced, 7.5M Extension Cable
    • (#2934) - Asynchronous Terminal/Printer Cable EIA-232
    • (#2936) - Asynchronous Cable EIA-232/V.24
    • (#3925) - Serial Port Converter Cable, 9-Pin to 25-Pin
    • (#3926) - Asynch Printer/Terminal Cable, 9-pin to 25-pin, 4M
    • (#3927) -Serial Port Null Modem Cable, 9-pin to 9-pin, 3.7M
    • (#3928) -Serial Port Null Modem Cable, 9-pin to 9-pin, 10M
    • (#8131) - 128-Port Asynchronous Controller Cable, 4.5 Meter
    • (#8132) - 128-Port Asynchronous Controller Cable, 23cm (9-Inch)
    • (#8133) - RJ-45 to DB-25 Converter Cable
    • (#8136) - Rack Mountable Remote Asynchronous Node 16-Port EIA-232
    • (#8137) - Enhanced Remote Asynchronous Node 16-Port EIA-232
    • (#4263) - SCSI Cables (Power and Logic), PCI Riser to SCSI LVD Media Device; Mounting Tray
    • (#4267) - SCSI Cable, PCI Adapter to Hot-Swap Disks
    • (#4274) - SCSI Cable, PCI Adapter to Hot-Swap Disks
    • (#4273) - External SCSI Port Enablement Cable
    • (#2114) - PCI SCSI Adapter 16-Bit Differential External Y Cable
    • (#2118) - Converter Cable, VHDCI to P, Mini-68 pin to 68 pin, 0.3M
    • (#2424) - 0.6M 16-bit SCSI-2 System to System Cable
    • (#2425) - 2.5M 16-bit SCSI-2 System to System Cable
    • (#2456) - LC-SC 50 Micron Fiber Converter Cable
    • (#2459) - LC-SC 62.5 Micron Fiber Converter Cable
    • (#4242) - 6 Foot Extender Cable for Displays (15 pin D-shell to 15 pin D-shell)
    • (#4256) - Extender Cable - USB Keyboards, 2M
    • (#7801) - Ethernet Cable, 6M, Hardware Management Console to System Unit
    • (#7802) - Ethernet Cable, 15M, Hardware Management Console to System Unit
    • (#2861) - ARTIC960Hx 4-Port EIA-232 Cable
    • (#2863) - ARTIC960Hx 4-Port X.21 Cable
    • (#2864) - ARTIC960Hx 4-Port V.35 (DTE) Cable
    • (#2951) - Cable, V.24 / EIA-232
    • (#2952) - Cable, V.35
    • (#2953) - Cable, V.36 / EIA-499
    • (#2954) - Cable, X.21
    • (#2877) - IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, H.100, 4-Drop Cable
    • (#3124) - Serial to Serial Port Cable for Drawer/Drawer
    • (#3125) - Serial to Serial Port Cable for Rack/Rack
    • (#4353) - H-100 Bus 8-position Cable
    • (#4691) - Rack Status Beacon Cable, Junction Box To Drawer Or Status Beacon
    • (#4692) - Rack Status Beacon Cable, Junction Box Daisy Chain
    • (#3146) - RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 1.2M
    • (#3147) - RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 3.5M
    • (#3148) - RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 10M
    • (#3156) - RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 1.75M
    • (#3168) - RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 2.5M
    • (#6006) - Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 3 meter
    • (#6029) - Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 30 meter

  • DISKS
    • (#3273) - 36.4 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
    • (#3274) - 73.4 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
    • (#3275) - 146.8 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
    • (#3277) - 36.4 GB 15,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
    • (#3278) - 73.4 GB 15,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
    • (#3279) - 146.8 GB 15,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
    • (#3578) - 300 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly
    • (#3647) - 146GB 15K RPM SAS Disk Drive
    • (#3648) - 300GB 15K RPM SAS Disk Drive
    • (#3649) - 450GB 15K RPM SAS Disk Drive
    • (#6598) - Disk Slot Fillers (Quantity 4)
    • (#7549) -Quantity 150 of #3647
    • (#7564) -Quantity 150 of #3648
    • (#7565) -Quantity 150 of #3649

  • DISPLAYS
    • (#3636) - L200P Flat Panel Monitor
    • (#3637) - IBM T541H /L150p 15" TFT Color Monitor
    • (#3638) - IBM C220p 21-inch Color Monitor, Business Black, and Cable
    • (#3639) - IBM ThinkVision L170p Flat Panel Monitor
    • (#3640) - IBM ThinkVision L171p Flat Panel Monitor
    • (#3641) - IBM T115 Flat Panel Monitor
    • (#3642) - ThinkVision L191p Flat Panel Monitor
    • (#3643) - IBM T120 Flat Panel Monitor
    • (#3644) - IBM T119 Flat Panel Monitor
    • (#3645) - IBM T117 Flat Panel Monitor

  • KEYBOARDS
    • (#5951) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, US English, #103P
    • (#5952) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, French, #189
    • (#5953) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Italian, #142
    • (#5954) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, German/Austrian, #129
    • (#5955) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, UK English, #166P
    • (#5956) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Spanish, #172
    • (#5957) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Japanese, #194
    • (#5958) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Brazilian Portuguese, #275
    • (#5959) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Hungarian, #208
    • (#5960) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Korean, #413
    • (#5961) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Chinese, #467
    • (#5962) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, French Canadian, #445
    • (#5963) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Canadian French, #058
    • (#5964) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Belgian/French, #120
    • (#5965) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Swedish/Finnish, #153
    • (#5966) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Danish, #159
    • (#5967) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Bulgarian, #442
    • (#5968) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Swiss/French/ German, #150
    • (#5969) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Norwegian,#155
    • (#5970) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Dutch, #143
    • (#5971) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Portuguese, #163
    • (#5972) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Greek, #319
    • (#5973) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Hebrew, #212
    • (#5974) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Polish, #214
    • (#5975) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Slovakian, #245
    • (#5976) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Czech, #243
    • (#5977) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Turkish, #179
    • (#5978) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, LA Spanish, #171
    • (#5979) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Arabic, #253
    • (#5980) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Thai, #191
    • (#5981) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Russian, #443
    • (#5982) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Slovenian, #234
    • (#5983) - Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, US English International, #103P
    • (#8800) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, US English, #103P
    • (#8801) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, French, #189
    • (#8802) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Italian, #142
    • (#8803) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, German/Austrian, #129
    • (#8804) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, UK English, #166
    • (#8805) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Spanish, #172
    • (#8806) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Japanese, #194
    • (#8807) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Brazilian/Portuguese, #275
    • (#8808) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Canadian French, #058
    • (#8810) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Belgian/Dutch, #120
    • (#8811) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Swedish/Finnish, #153
    • (#8812) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Danish, #159
    • (#8813) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Bulgarian, #442
    • (#8814) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Swiss/French/German, #150F/G
    • (#8816) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Norwegian, #155
    • (#8817) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Dutch, #143
    • (#8818) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Portuguese, #163
    • (#8819) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Greek, #319
    • (#8820) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Hebrew, #212
    • (#8821) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Hungarian, #208
    • (#8823) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Polish, #214
    • (#8825) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Slovakian, #245
    • (#8826) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Czech, #243
    • (#8827) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Turkish, #179
    • (#8829) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, LA Spanish, #171
    • (#8830) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Arabic, #238
    • (#8833) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Korean, #413
    • (#8834) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Chinese/US, #467
    • (#8835) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, French Canadian, #445
    • (#8836) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Thai, #191
    • (#8838) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Russian, #443
    • (#8839) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Yugoslavian/Latin, #105
    • (#8840) - Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, US English (EMEA), #103P

  • MEMORY
    • (#4443) - 512MB (2x256MB) DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR SDRAM
    • (#4444) - 1024MB (4x256MB) DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR SDRAM
    • (#4445) - 4096MB (4x1024MB) DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR SDRAM
    • (#4447) - 2048MB (4x512MB) DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR SDRAM
    • (#4449) - 8192MB (4x2048MB) DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR Stacked SDRAM
    • (#4450) - 16GB (4x4096MB) DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR Stacked SDRAM

  • Pointing Device
    • (#8845) -USB Mouse

  • POWER
    • (#7876) - Processor Power Regulator
    • (#7889) - Power Supply, 1475 watt AC, Hot-swap, Base and Redundant

  • MEDIA DEVICES
    • (#2591) - External USB 1.44 MB Diskette Drive
    • (#6120) - IBM 80/160 GB Internal Tape Drive with VXA Technology
    • (#6134) - 60/150 GB 16-bit 8mm Internal Tape Drive
    • (#6258) - 36/72GB 4mm Internal Tape Drive
    • (#6279) - VXA-320 160/320GB Internal Tape Drive
    • (#2640) - IDE Slimline DVD-ROM Drive
    • (#5751) - IBM 4.7 GB IDE Slimline DVD-RAM Drive

  • LINECORDS
    • (#6458) - Power Cable -- Drawer to IBM PDU, 14-foot, 250V/10A
    • (#6460) - Power Cord (14-foot), Drawer to OEM PDU (125V, 15A), Plug Type #4
    • (#6469) - Power Cord (14-foot), Drawer to OEM PDU (250V, 15A), United States, Plug Type #5
    • (#6470) - Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall (125V, 15A), Plug Type #4
    • (#6471) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (125V, 15A), Plug Type #70
    • (#6472) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 16A), Plug Type #18
    • (#6473) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #19
    • (#6474) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 13A), Plug Type #23
    • (#6475) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 16A), Plug Type #32
    • (#6476) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #24
    • (#6477) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 16A), Plug Type #22
    • (#6478) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 16A), Plug Type #25
    • (#6479) - Power Cord (9-foot) , To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #6
    • (#6487) - Power Cord (6-foot) ,To Wall, (250V, 15A), United States, Plug Type #5
    • (#6488) - Power Cord (9-foot) , To Wall/OEM PDU, (125V, 15A or 250V, 10A), Plug Type #2
    • (#6493) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #62
    • (#6494) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #69
    • (#6495) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #64
    • (#6496) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #66
    • (#6497) - Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 15A), Plug Type #10
    • (#6498) - Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 15A), Plug Type #34
    • (#6651) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (125V, 15A), Plug Type #75
    • (#6659) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 15A), Plug Type #76
    • (#6660) - Power Cord (14-foot), Drawer To OEM PDU (125V, 15A), Plug Type #59 (DENAN marking)
    • (#6669) - Power Cord (14-foot), Drawer to OEM PDU, (250V, 15A), Plug Type #57 (DENAN marking)
    • (#6670) - Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall (125V, 15A), Plug Type #59 (DENAN marking)
    • (#6671) - Power Cord (9-foot), Drawer to IBM PDU, 250V/10A
    • (#6672) -Power Cord 2M (6.5-foot), Drawer to IBM PDU, 250V/10A
    • (#6680) - Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #6, Insulated
    • (#6687) - Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall, (250V, 15A), Plug Type #57 (DENAN marking)

  • MISCELLANEOUS
    • (#3752) - Service Package
    • (#6592) - Ultra320 SCSI 4-Pack
    • (#6593) - Ultra320 SCSI 4-Pack for Disk Mirroring
    • (#7877) - Media Backplane
    • (#7887) - IBM Deskside Cover Set
    • (#7930) - On/Off Processor Enablement for CoD
    • (#7931) - On/Off Processor Billing for CoD
    • (#7934) - 30 Days Prepaid Reserve Capacity for CoD
    • (#8841) - Mouse - Business Black with Keyboard Attachment Cable

  • PROCESSORS
    • (#5237) - 2-Way 1.65 GHz POWER5 CUoD Processor Card, 0-Way Active, 8 Memory DIMM Slots
    • (#5239) - 1-way 1.5 GHz POWER5 Processor Card, No L3 Cache
    • (#5264) - 2-way 1.5 GHz POWER5 Processor Card, 36MB L3 Cache, DDR 1 Memory DIMMs
    • (#7601) - One Processor Entitlement for Processor Feature #5239
    • (#7603) - One Processor Activation for Processor Feature #5264
    • (#7871) - One Processor Activation for CUoD Processor Feature #5237
    • (#8450) - Zero-priced Value Pak Processor Activation Code for #5237
    • (#8463) - Zero-priced Value Pak Processor Entitlement for #5239
    • (#8465) - Zero-priced Value Pak Processor Activation Code for #5264

  • RACK RELATED
    • (#4693) - Rack Status Beacon Junction Box
    • (#5886) - EXP 12S Expansion Drawer
    • (#7162) - IBM/OEM Rack-mount Drawer Rail Kit
    • (#7163) - OEM Rack-mount Drawer Rail Kit
    • (#7886) - IBM Rack-mount Drawer Bezel and Hardware

Feature descriptions

The following is a list of all feature codes in numeric order.

Attributes, as defined in the following feature descriptions, state the interaction of requirements among features.

Minimums and maximums are the absolute limits for a single feature without regard to interaction with other features. The maximum valid quantity for MES orders may be different than for initial orders. The maximums listed below refer to the largest quantity of these two possibilities.

The order type defines if a feature is orderable only on initial orders, only on MES orders, on both initial and MES orders, or if a feature is supported on a model due to a model conversion. Supported features cannot be ordered on the converted model, only left on or removed from the converted model.

(#0050) - IBM Express Seller Indicator

This is a no-charge feature used for administrative purposes by IBM and IBM Business Partners.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#0050)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#0265) AIX Partition Specify

This feature code is used to indicate the number of partitions that the system will have running under AIX.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#0265)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 40 (Initial order maximum: 40)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3 or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#0266) Linux Partition Specify

This feature code is used to indicate the number of partitions that the system will have running under Linux.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#0266)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 40 (Initial order maximum: 40)
    • OS level required: SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later, or Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS for POWER Version 3
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#0983) - US TAA Compliance Indicator

This feature indicates that the product was assembled in a manufacturing plant in the USA or in a country approved under the US Trade Agreement Act.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#0983)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#0986) CCS Customer Service Specify (US)

This feature code specifies that the system will receive special request services from the Center for Customized Solutions (CCS).

FC 0986 is available only on the initial plant order.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#0986)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#1806) Dual Port RIO-2 I/O Hub

(No Longer Available as of May 28, 2010)

This feature provides an adapter plus interposer card that connects slot #5 in the p5 model 550 (9113-550) to the system backplane and provides two additional external RIO-2 ports for external connectivity or I/O drawer expansion.

  • Attributes provided: Two external RIO-2 ports
  • Attributes required: Slot #5 on the model 550; two processor cards installed in the system
  • For 9113-550: (#1806)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3 or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#1809) GX Dual-port 4x IB HCA

(No Longer Available as of May 28, 2010)

The #1809, GX Dual-port 4x InfiniBand Host Channel Adapter, provides an adapter plus interposer card that enables the attachment to the Topspin Server Switch models 120 and 270. This adapter plus interposer card plugs into the system backplane (GX slot). Connection to the Topspin Server Switches are accomplished by using the 4x IB Cables.

  • Attributes provided: 2 ports of 4x IB to attach to the Topspin Server Switch models 120 and 270
  • Attributes required: Available GX slot position
  • For 9113-550: (#1809)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1 )
    • OS level required: AIX 5.3, or later. SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later.
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#1820) PCI-X Dual-port 4x IB HCA

(No Longer Available as of June 23, 2006)

The #1820, PCI-X Dual-port 4x InfiniBand Host Channel Adapter, provides attachment to the Topspin Server Switch models 120 and 270. Connection to the Topspin Server Switches are accomplished by using the 4x IB Cables.

  • Attributes provided: 2 ports of 4x IB to attach to the Topspin Server Switch models 120 and 270
  • Attributes required: Available PCI-X slot
  • For 9113-550: (#1820)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 2 )
    • OS level required: AIX 5.3, or later. SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later.
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#1835) 3 meter 4x IB Cable

(No Longer Available as of June 23, 2006)

This 3 meter 4x IB cable is utilized for InfiniBand applications.

  • Attributes provided: 3 meter 4x IB cable
  • Attributes required: 4x IB port
  • For 9113-550: (#1835)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max )
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#1836) 8 meter 4x IB Cable

(No Longer Available as of June 23, 2006)

This 8 meter 4x IB cable is utilized for InfiniBand applications.

  • Attributes provided: 8 meter 4x IB cable
  • Attributes required: 4x IB port
  • For 9113-550: (#1836)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max )
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#1839) 1.5 meter 4x Cable

(No Longer Available as of June 23, 2006)

This 1.5 meter 4x cable is utilized to connect to supported InfiniBand switches.

  • Attributes provided: 1.5 meter 4x cable
  • Attributes required: 4x port
  • For 9113-550: (#1839)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max )
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2114) PCI SCSI Adapter 16-Bit Differential External Y Cable

(No Longer Available as of June 23, 2006)

  • Attributes provided: Attachment of multiple hosts to the PCI SCSI-2 differential adapter
  • Attributes required: 1 external SCSI-2 Fast/Wide Port
  • For 9113-550: (#2114)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2118) Converter Cable, VHDCI to P, Mini-68 pin to 68 pin, 0.3M

(No Longer Available as of June 23, 2006)

0.3M 16-bit SCSI cable used to convert from a Mini-68 pin VHDCI connector to a 68-pin P style connector. Cable has male Mini-68 pin VHDCI connector on one end and a female 68 pin P style connector on the other. Length = 0.3 meters.

  • Attributes provided: Attachment of supported external sub-system to integrated SCSI port or SCSI adapter with VHDCI Mini-68 pin connector.
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#2118)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2424) 0.6M 16-bit SCSI-2 System to System Cable

(No Longer Available as of December 10, 2004)

This cable provides a 16-bit connection between any two differential or single ended SCSI devices having 68-pin connectors. It can be used to attach an external SCSI device to a SCSI adapter card in an RS/6000 system.

  • Attributes provided: 0.6 meter SCSI cable with 68-pin connectors at each end
  • Attributes required: 68-pin SCSI Interface
  • For 9113-550: (#2424)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2425) 2.5M 16-bit SCSI-2 System to System Cable

(No Longer Available as of June 23, 2006)

This cable provides a 16-bit connection between any two differential or single ended SCSI devices having 68-pin connectors. It can be used to attach an external SCSI device to a SCSI adapter card in an RS/6000 system.

  • Attributes provided: 2.5 meter SCSI cable with 68-pin connectors at each end
  • Attributes required: 68-pin SCSI Interface
  • For 9113-550: (#2425)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2456) LC-SC 50 Micron Fiber Converter Cable

50 micron fiber cable used to convert from LC type to SC type connectors. Cable has male LC type connector on one end and a female SC type connector on the other. Length = 2 meters.

  • Attributes provided: Attachment to external 50 micron fabric or device with one type fiber connector to an adapter with the other type fiber connector.
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#2456)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No Max (Initial order maximum: No Max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2459) LC-SC 62.5 Micron Fiber Converter Cable

62.5 micron fiber cable used to convert from LC type to SC type connectors. Cable has male LC type connector on one end and a female SC type connector on the other. Length = 2 meters.

  • Attributes provided: Attachment to external 62.5 micron fabric or device with one type fiber connector to an adapter with the other type fiber connector.
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#2459)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No Max (Initial order maximum: No Max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2591) External USB 1.44 MB Diskette Drive

The externally attached USB diskette drive provides storage capacity up to 1.44 MB on a high density (2HD) floppy disk and 720 KB on a double density floppy disk. Includes 350mm (13.7 in) captured cable with standard USB connector.

Limitation:

  • Maximum 1 USB diskette per adapter,
  • Up to 1 Keyboard and Mouse also supported on the adapter with the diskette drive at the same time
  • No system boot capability
  • Not to be operated upside down or with eject button down

Characteristics:

  • Capacity - 1.44 MB (2HD disk) or 720 KB (double density disk)
  • Physical Dimensions: Width=103mm (4.05 in), Height=17.6mm (.69 in), Depth=141.8mm (5.58 in)
  • Color: Black
  • Data Rate: 12 Mbits/sec
  • Max Power Consumption: 2.36 Watt (seek)
  • Operates in all positions except those noted in the limitations above
  • Attributes provided: External diskette drive
  • Attributes required: 1 available USB port
  • For 9113-550: (#2591)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2640) IDE Slimline DVD-ROM Drive

(No Longer Available as of May 29, 2009)

The 8X/24X(max) Slimline IDE DVD-ROM Drive is an internal tray loading DVD-ROM drive providing up to 3600KB/sec (CD-ROM) and 10.3MB/sec (DVD-ROM) data transfer rates. It is a 12.7mm Slimline form factor multi-session capable, DVD-ROM drive which provides state of the art performance and supports existing 650MB CD-ROM, 4.7 GB DVD-ROM, and 9.4 GB DVD-ROM (double-sided) discs. This drive also reads Type II (removable from cartridge) DVD-RAM discs at DVD-ROM speeds. System boot and install functions are supported with CD-ROM and DVD-RAM media.

Characteristics:

  • Media Data Transfer Rate: CD-ROM=3600 KB/sec (max): DVD-ROM=10.3MB/sec (max)
  • Interface: IDE/ATAPI
  • Avg. Random Access Time: CD-ROM=95ms(typical); DVD-ROM=150ms(typical)
  • Buffer Memory: 256KB
  • Media capacity: CD-ROM=650MB; DVD-ROM= 4.7 GB(single sided); 9.4 GB(double-sided)
  • Multisession capable (Reads CD/R & CD-R/W media)
  • 12.7mm Slimline form factor
  • Operates in either vertical or horizontal positions
  • Interface supports standard and extended XA formats
  • Loading tray supports 12cm and 8cm disks

Limitations:

  • DVD video is not supported.
  • DVD-ROM only reads CD-type formatted media with AIX 5.1.
  • Attributes provided: 8X/24X(max) IDE DVD-ROM Drive
  • Attributes required: 1 Slimline media bay
  • For 9113-550: (#2640)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2709) - ARTIC960Hx/RxD 4-Port T1 RJ-45 Cable

4-Port T1 RJ-48 cable for the ARTIC960Hx 4-Port T1/E1 PCI Adapter or ARTIC960RxD Quad Digital Trunk adapter.

  • Attributes provided: 4-Port T1 RJ48 cable
  • Attributes required: 4-port T1/E1 Adapter or Quad Digital Trunk Adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#2709)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Support
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#2710) - ARTIC960Hx/RxD 4-Port E1 RJ-45 Cable

4-Port E1 RJ-48 cable for the ARTIC960Hx 4-Port T1/E1 PCI Adapter or the ARTIC960RxD Quad Digital Trunk Adapter.

  • Attributes provided: 4-Port E1 RJ-48 cable
  • Attributes required: 4-port T1/E1 Adapter or Quad Digital Trunk Adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#2710)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Support
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#2738) 2 Port USB PCI Adapter

(No Longer Available as of November 27, 2009)

The 2 Port USB PCI Adapter is a USB 2.0 capable adapter that provides for the connection of one USB keyboard and mouse. Limitation: Limited to USB 1.1 support with AIX

  • Attributes provided: USB Keyboard/Mouse Attachment
  • Attributes required: One available PCI slot
  • For 9113-550: (#2738)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2849) POWER GXT135P Graphics Accelerator with Digital Support

(No Longer Available as of November 27, 2009)

The POWER GXT135P is a versatile, low-priced 2D graphics accelerator for RS/6000 workstations and pSeries servers. It can be configured to operate in either 8-bit or 24-bit color modes. This adapter supports both analog and digital monitors. Its predecessor, Feature Number 2848, supported only analog monitors.

  • Hardware Description:
    • 128-bit graphics processor
    • 8-bit CLUT or 24-bit true color
    • 16 MB SDRAM
    • 32-bit PCI interface
    • Universal PCI (5.0v or 3.3v)
    • 1 hardware color map
  • Features Supported:
    • Up to approximately 16.7 million colors
    • Rectangular clipping
    • 2 analog monitor outputs at up to 1280 x 1024 resolution
    • 1 analog monitor output at up to 2048 x 1536 resolution
    • 1 digital monitor output at up to 1600 x 1200 resolution
    • 60 to 85 Hz refresh rates (ISO 9241, Part 3)
  • APIs Supported:
    • X-Windows and Motif
    • UMS 2.3.0 (no hardware scaling)
  • Software Requirements: AIX Versions 5.1 or 5.2 (analog or digital support),or later, or AIX 4.3 (analog support only)
  • Attributes provided: 2D Graphics
  • Attributes required: 1 PCI slot
  • For 9113-550: (#2849)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2861) ARTIC960Hx 4-Port EIA-232 Cable

(No Longer Available as of August 25, 2006)

  • Attributes provided: 4-port EIA-232 cable for (#2947)
  • Attributes required: One #2947 adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#2861)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: Requires fc# 2947.

(#2863) ARTIC960Hx 4-Port X.21 Cable

(No Longer Available as of August 25, 2006)

  • Attributes provided: 4-port X.21 cable for (#2947)
  • Attributes required: One #2947 adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#2863)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: Requires fc# 2947.

(#2864) ARTIC960Hx 4-Port V.35 (DTE) Cable

(No Longer Available as of August 25, 2006)

  • Attributes provided: 4-port X.35 (DTE) cable for (#2947)
  • Attributes required: One #2947 adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#2864)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: Requires fc# 2947.

(#2871) - IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, T1, 100 Ohm, 3M 4-Port Cable

  • Attributes provided: Connection of 1 to 4 T1 Trunk lines.
  • Attributes required: One (#6310) adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#2871)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Support
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#2872) - IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, T1, 100 Ohm, 15M Extension Cable

  • Attributes provided: Connection of 1 to 4 T1 Trunk lines.
  • Attributes required: One (#6310) adapter and (#2871) cable
  • For 9113-550: (#2872)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Support
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#2873) - IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, E1, 120 Ohm Balanced, 3M 4-Port Cable

  • Attributes provided: Connection of 1 to 4 E1 Trunk lines.
  • Attributes required: One (#6310) adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#2873)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Support
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#2874) - IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, E1, 120 Ohm Balanced, 7.5M Extension Cable

  • Attributes provided: Connection of 1 to 4 E1 Trunk lines.
  • Attributes required: One (#6310) adapter and #2873) cable
  • For 9113-550: (#2874)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Support
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#2877) IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, H.100, 4-Drop Cable

(No Longer Available as of November 26, 2010)

This cable provides the capability to interconnect adapters that provide H.100 bus connectors. This 4-position cable should be used when four or less adapters with H.100 connectors will be interconnected. When more than 4 and less than or equal to 8 adapters will be connected, the H.100 Bus 8-Drop Cable (#4353) should be used.

  • Attributes provided: H.100 bus connection between adapters
  • Attributes required: Two to Four H.100 adapters
  • For 9113-550: (#2877)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: No
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2934) Asynchronous Terminal/Printer Cable EIA-232

The Asynchronous Printer/Terminal Cable is used for attaching printers, plotters, and terminals that support the EIA-232 standard to any asynchronous adapter. This cable is the equivalent of the combination of FC 2936 (modem cable) and FC 2937 (printer/terminal interposer) and replaces this method of printer/terminal attachment.

This cable is 3m (9.8 feet) long, uses DB25 connectors and is supported on all RS/6000 systems using any asynchronous ports. It is used in conjunction with:

  • FC 2931 (8-port Async Adapter EIA232, ISA bus)
  • FC 8133 (RJ45-DB25 converter cable for 16-port RANs 8130, 8134, 8136)
  • Attributes provided: EIA232 device attachment capability
  • Attributes required: Any RS/6000 Asynchronous port
  • For 9113-550: (#2934)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2936) Asynchronous Cable EIA-232/V.24

Used to attach a modem to the standard I/O ports with the 10-pin to 25-pin converter cable (#3925), 8-port Cable Assembly, 16-Port Cable Assembly, 16-Port Asynchronous Concentrator (with RJ-45 to DB-25 Converter Cable feature #6402) or the 16-Port EIA-232 Remote Async Node (with RJ45 to DB25 Converter Cable feature #8133). The cable is 3 meters (9.8 feet) in length.

  • Attributes provided: Modem attachment to async or serial port
  • Attributes required: Async or serial port
  • For 9113-550: (#2936)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2943) 8-Port Asynchronous Adapter EIA-232/RS-422, PCI bus

(No Longer Available as of November 27, 2009)

For connection of up to 8 asynchronous EIA-232 or RS-422 devices. All eight ports are software programmable to support either EIA-232E or RS-422A protocols, at up to 230K baud.

  • Attributes provided: 8 Async ports
  • Attributes required: One PCI slot
  • For 9113-550: (#2943)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2944) 128-Port Asynchronous Controller, PCI bus

(No Longer Available as of March 31, 2006)

The 128-Port Async Adapter subsystem provides attachment for a high concentration of asynchronous lines (up to 128) from a single PCI bus slot. This gives the system the ability to serve a large number of user of EIA-232 or RS-422 devices such as terminals, printers, and modems.

Two 2.4 Mbps synchronous channels link the adapter to a maximum of eight 16-Port Remote Async Nodes (RANs), up to four RANs can be linked to each synchronous channel.

RANs can also be used with this adapter. If these RANs are connected the synchronous channel the data rate drops down to 1.2 Mbps. For the best results keep the previous and new RANs on separate synchronous channels.

  • Attributes provided: Up to 128 Async Ports
  • Attributes required: One PCI slot, One to eight (#8137) or (#8138)
  • For 9113-550: (#2944)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2947) IBM ARTIC960Hx 4-Port Multiprotocol PCI Adapter

(No Longer Available as of October 13, 2006)

The IBM ARTIC960Hx 4-Port Selectable PCI Adapter (#2947) is a one-slot, standard length, 32-bit PCI card. The adapter provides 4-Ports of: EIA-232, EIA530, RS-449, X.21, or V.35. Each port will support speeds of up 2.0M bps. Software support is provided by ARTIC960 Support for AIX, Developer's Kit, AIX Versions 4.2.1 or 4.3.2 or later that provide SDLC and Bisync support; AIX Versions 4.1.5, 4.2.1, 4.3.1 or later that provide AIXLink X.25 LPP Version 1.1.5 support.

Note: This adapter may have AIX 5.1 support limitations. Go to to the following URL to view the latest AIX 5.1 support limitation statements.

http://www.ibm.com/servers/aix/os/adapters/51.html

  • Attributes provided: One to four WAN connections at up to 2.0Mbps
  • Attributes required: One full length 32-bit PCI slot, AIX Version 4.2.1 or 4.3.2 or later (for SDLC or Bisync support); AIX Version 4.1.5, 4.2.1, 4.3.1 or later (for AIXLink X.25 LPP Version 1.1.5 support).
  • For 9113-550: (#2947)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2951) Cable, V.24 / EIA-232

(No Longer Available as of May 31, 2006)

V.24 cable for use with #2962 - 2-Port Multiprotocol Adapter. Maximum of two cables per #2962.

  • For 9113-550: (#2951)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2952) Cable, V.35

(No Longer Available as of May 31, 2006)

V.35 cable for use with #2962 - 2-Port Multiprotocol Adapter. Maximum of two cables per #2962.

  • For 9113-550: (#2952)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2953) Cable, V.36 / EIA-499

(No Longer Available as of May 31, 2006)

V.36/EIA-499 cable for use with #2962 - 2-Port Multiprotocol Adapter. Maximum of two cables per #2962.

  • For 9113-550: (#2953)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2954) Cable, X.21

(No Longer Available as of May 31, 2006)

X.21 cable for use with #2962 - 2-Port Multiprotocol Adapter. Maximum of two cables per #2962.

  • For 9113-550: (#2954)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#2962) 2-Port Multiprotocol PCI Adapter

(No Longer Available as of May 31, 2006)

This adapter provides high-speed connections between stand-alone system units on a WAN. To access WAN lines, the 2-Port Multiprotocol PCI Adapter connects via external communications equipment including Channel Service Units (CSU), Data Service Units (DSU), or through synchronous modems.

This adapter together with IBM AIXlink/X.25 provides a two-port connection to X.25 packet switched networks. IBM AIXlink/X.25 is a separately orderable LPP (5696-926).

2-Port Multiprotocol PCI Adapter with an appropriate cable is compatible with:

  • X.21 DCE - Using 2-Port Cable, X.21 (#2954)
    • CCITT X.21 Signalling
    • CCITT V.11 Electrical
    • CCITT X.27 Electrical
    • EIA-422-A Electrical
    • ISO 4903 Connector for DCE side of an X.21 VHSI Modem Cable

  • V.24 DCE - Using 2-Port Cable, V.24/EIA-232 (#2951)
    • CCITT V.24 Signalling
    • CCITT V.28 Electrical
    • CCITT X.21bis Electrical and Signalling
    • EIA-232-C Electrical and Signalling
    • ISO 2110 Connector for DCE side of an V.24 VHSI Modem Cable

  • V.35 DCE - Using 2-Port Cable, V.35 (#2952)
    • CCITT V.35 Some signals for signalling
    • CCITT V.28 Some signals for electrical and signalling
    • ISO 2593 Connector for DCE side of an V.35 VHSI Modem Cable

  • V.36 DCE - Using 2-Port Cable, V.36/EIA-449 (#2953)
    • CCITT V.10 Electrical
    • CCITT V.11 Electrical

  • Attributes provided: Two high speed WAN connections

  • Attributes required: One PCI slot

  • For 9113-550: (#2962)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3124) Serial to Serial Port Cable for Drawer/Drawer

This 3.7 meter cable is available to provide a null-modem connection between the serial ports of two system drawers that are mounted within the same rack. The cable provides a DB25 female connector at each end.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#3124)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3125) Serial to Serial Port Cable for Rack/Rack

This 8 meter cable is available to provide a null-modem connection between the serial ports of two system drawers that are mounted in separate racks. The cable provides a DB25 female connector at each end.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#3125)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3146) RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 1.2M

(No Longer Available as of January 7, 2011)

This 1.2-meter RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) cable connects two RIO-2 based I/O planars within an I/O drawer.

  • Attributes provided: 1.2M RIO-2 Cable
  • Attributes required: I/O Drawer and two RIO-2 I/O planars
  • For 9113-550: (#3146)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3147) RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 3.5M

(No Longer Available as of May 27, 2011)

This 3 1/2 meter RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2)cable is available to connect the processor complex and the I/O drawers. It can also be utilized to connect I/O drawers mounted in separate racks.

  • Attributes provided: Interconnection of CEC and I/O drawers
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#3147)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3148) RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 10M

(No Longer Available as of May 27, 2011)

This 10 meter RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) cable is available to connect the processor complex and the I/O drawers. It can also be utilized to connect I/O drawers mounted in separate racks.

  • Attributes provided: Interconnection of CEC and I/O drawers
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#3148)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3156) RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 1.75M

(No Longer Available as of December 12, 2008)

This 1.75 meter RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) cable is utilized to connect RIO-2 based I/O planars and I/O drawers to the system CEC.

  • Attributes provided: 1.75M RIO-2 Cable
  • Attributes required: I/O Drawer and two RIO-2 connectors on the system CEC.
  • For 9113-550: (#3156)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3168) RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) Cable, 2.5M

(No Longer Available as of May 27, 2011)

This 2.5 meter RIO-2 (Remote I/O-2) cable is utilized to connect RIO-2 based I/O planars and I/O drawers to the system CEC.

  • Attributes provided: 2.5M RIO-2 Cable
  • Attributes required: I/O Drawer and two RIO-2 connectors on the system CEC.
  • For 9113-550: (#3168)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3273) 36.4 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly

(No Longer Available as of March 31, 2005)

The 36.4 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly provides 36.4 GB of storage capacity and supports the industry standard Ultra320 SCSI interface speed of up to 320 MBps.

Characteristics:

  • Form Factor: 3.5-inch, 1-inch (25 mm) high
  • Cable included: No
  • External Interface: Ultra320 SCSI (16-bit, Low Voltage Differential)
  • Attachment Industry Spec: SCSI U320
  • Average Seek Time: 4.82 ms (based on four(4) READS to one(1) WRITE)
  • Average Latency: 2.99 ms
  • Rotational Speed: 10,000 RPM
  • Maximum Data Transfer Rate: 67 MBps

Limitation: This disk drive requires attachment to a supported Ultra320 SCSI Adapter in an system that supports an Ultra320 SCSI cable/backplane in order for the drive to run at 320 MBps. Also, any and all other SCSI devices on the same SCSI bus must also be Ultra2, Ultra3, or Ultra320 SCSI device(s) in order for this disk drive to run at 320 MBps.

  • Attributes provided: 36.4 GB of disk storage mounted in a carrier.
  • Attributes required: One disk drive bay.
  • For 9113-550: (#3273)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 8 (Initial order maximum: 8)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3274) 73.4 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly

(No Longer Available as of May 25, 2007)

The 73.4 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly provides 73.4 GB of storage capacity and supports the industry standard Ultra320 SCSI interface speed of up to 320 MBps.

Characteristics:

  • Form Factor: 3.5-inch, 1-inch (25 mm) high
  • Cable included: No
  • External Interface: Ultra320 SCSI (16-bit, Low Voltage Differential)
  • Attachment Industry Spec: SCSI U320
  • Average Seek Time: 4.82 ms (based on four(4) READS to one(1) WRITE)
  • Average Latency: 2.99 ms
  • Rotational Speed: 10,000 RPM
  • Maximum Data Transfer Rate: 67 MBps

Limitation: This disk drive requires attachment to a supported Ultra320 SCSI Adapter in an system that supports an Ultra320 SCSI cable/backplane in order for the drive to run at 320 MBps. Also, any and all other SCSI devices on the same SCSI bus must also be Ultra2, Ultra3, or Ultra320 SCSI device(s) in order for this disk drive to run at 320 MBps.

  • Attributes provided: 73.4 GB of disk storage mounted in a carrier.
  • Attributes required: One disk drive bay.
  • For 9113-550: (#3274)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 8 (Initial order maximum: 8)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3275) 146.8 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly

(No Longer Available as of May 25, 2007)

The 146.8 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly provides 146.8 GB of storage capacity and supports the industry standard Ultra320 SCSI interface speed of up to 320 MBps.

Characteristics:

  • Form Factor: 3.5-inch, 1-inch (25 mm) high
  • Cable included: No
  • External Interface: Ultra320 SCSI (16-bit, Low Voltage Differential)
  • Attachment Industry Spec: SCSI U320
  • Average Seek Time: 4.94 ms (based on four(4) READS to one(1) WRITE)
  • Average Latency: 2.99 ms
  • Rotational Speed: 10,000 RPM
  • Maximum Data Transfer Rate: 67 MBps

Limitation: This disk drive requires attachment to a supported Ultra320 SCSI Adapter in a system that supports an Ultra320 SCSI cable/backplane in order for the drive to run at 320 MBps. Also, any and all other SCSI devices on the same SCSI bus must also be Ultra2, Ultra3, or Ultra320 SCSI device(s) in order for this disk drive to run at 320 MBps.

  • Attributes provided: 146.8 GB of disk storage mounted in a carrier.
  • Attributes required: One disk drive bay.
  • For 9113-550: (#3275)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 8 (Initial order maximum: 8)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3 or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3277) 36.4 GB 15,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly

(No Longer Available as of February 23, 2007)

The 36.4 GB 15,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly provides 36.4 GB of storage capacity and supports the industry standard Ultra3 SCSI interface speed of up to 320 MBps.

Characteristics:

  • Form Factor: 3.5-inch, 1-inch (25 mm) high
  • Cable included: No
  • External Interface: Ultra320 SCSI (16-bit, Low Voltage Differential)
  • Attachment Industry Spec: SCSI U320
  • Average Seek Time: 3.7 ms (based on four(4) READS to one(1) WRITE)
  • Average Latency: 2 ms
  • Rotational Speed: 15,000 RPM
  • Maximum Data Transfer Rate: 83 MBps

Limitation: This disk drive requires attachment to a supported Ultra320 SCSI Adapter in a system that supports an Ultra320 SCSI cable/backplane in order for the drive to run at 320 MBps. Also, any and all other SCSI devices on the same SCSI bus must also be Ultra2, Ultra3, or Ultra320 SCSI device(s) in order for this disk drive to run at 320 MBps.

  • Attributes provided: 36.4 GB of disk storage mounted in a carrier.
  • Attributes required: One disk drive bay.
  • For 9113-550: (#3277)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 8 (Initial order maximum: 8)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3278) 73.4 GB 15,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly

(No Longer Available as of January 30, 2009)

The 73.4 GB 15,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly provides 73.4 GB of storage capacity and supports the industry standard Ultra3 SCSI interface speed of up to 320 MBps.

Characteristics:

  • Form Factor: 3.5-inch, 1-inch (25 mm) high
  • Cable included: No
  • External Interface: Ultra320 SCSI (16-bit, Low Voltage Differential)
  • Attachment Industry Spec: SCSI U320
  • Average Seek Time: 3.7 ms (based on four(4) READS to one(1) WRITE)
  • Average Latency: 2 ms
  • Rotational Speed: 15,000 RPM
  • Maximum Data Transfer Rate: 83 MBps

Limitation: This disk drive requires attachment to a supported Ultra320 SCSI Adapter in a system that supports an Ultra320 SCSI cable/backplane in order for the drive to run at 320 MBps. Also, any and all other SCSI devices on the same SCSI bus must also be Ultra2, Ultra3, or Ultra320 SCSI device(s) in order for this disk drive to run at 320 MBps.

  • Attributes provided: 73.4 GB of disk storage mounted in a carrier.
  • Attributes required: One disk drive bay.
  • For 9113-550: (#3278)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 8 (Initial order maximum: 8)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3279) 146.8 GB 15,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly

(No Longer Available as of August 28, 2009)

The 146.8 GB 15,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly provides 146.8 GB of storage capacity and supports the industry standard Ultra3 SCSI interface speed of up to 320 MBps.

Characteristics:

  • Form Factor: 3.5-inch, 1-inch (25 mm) high
  • Cable included: No
  • External Interface: Ultra320 SCSI (16-bit, Low Voltage Differential)
  • Attachment Industry Spec: SCSI U320
  • Average Seek Time: 3.7 ms (based on four (4) READS to one (1) WRITE)
  • Average Latency: 2 ms
  • Rotational Speed: 15,000 RPM
  • Maximum Data Transfer Rate:107 MBps

Limitation: This disk drive requires attachment to a supported Ultra320 SCSI Adapter in a system that supports an Ultra320 SCSI cable/backplane in order for the drive to run at 320 MBps. Also, any and all other SCSI devices on the same SCSI bus must also be Ultra2, Ultra3, or Ultra320 SCSI device(s) in order for this disk drive to run at 320 MBps.

  • Attributes provided: 146.8 GB of disk storage mounted in a carrier.
  • Attributes required: One disk drive bay.
  • For 9113-550: (#3279)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 8 (Initial order maximum: 8 )
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3578) - 300 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly

(No Longer Available as of September 14, 2007)

The 300 GB 10,000 RPM Ultra320 SCSI Disk Drive Assembly provides 300 GB of storage capacity and supports the industry standard Ultra320 SCSI interface speed of up to 320 MBps.

Characteristics:

  • Form Factor: 3.5-inch, 1-inch (25 mm) high
  • Cable included: No
  • External Interface: Ultra320 SCSI (16-bit, Low Voltage Differential)
  • Attachment Industry Spec: SCSI U320
  • Average Seek Time: 4.9 ms (based on four(4) READS to one(1) WRITE)
  • Average Latency: 2.99 ms
  • Rotational Speed: 10,000 RPM
  • Maximum Data Transfer Rate: 88 MBps

Limitation: This disk drive requires attachment to a supported Ultra320 SCSI Adapter in a system that supports an Ultra320 SCSI cable/backplane in order for the drive to run at 320 MBps. Also, any and all other SCSI devices on the same SCSI bus must also be Ultra2, Ultra3, or Ultra320 SCSI device(s) in order for this disk drive to run at 320 MBps.

  • Attributes provided: 300 GB of disk storage mounted in a carrier.
  • Attributes required: One disk drive bay.
  • For 9113-550: (#3578)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 8 (Initial order maximum: 8)
    • OS level required: AIX V4.3 or higher PSSP levels 3.1, 3.2 and higher Linux- Refer to the following Web Site for Linux information:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eservers/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3636) L200P Flat Panel Monitor

(No Longer Available as of June 16, 2006)

The L200p flat-panel monitor has the following general characteristics:

  • Business black color
  • 20.1-inch TFT LCD digital screen with a viewable image size of 510 mm (20.1 inches) measured diagonally, incorporating a 0.255 mm pixel pitch/type for bright, high-definition images.
  • Designed to provide flicker free operation at a maximum resolution of 1600 x 1200 pels at 75Hz in analog mode and 1600 x 1200 pels at 60Hz in digital mode.
  • Tilt/swivel stand
  • Attributes provided: Color Flat-panel Monitor
  • Attributes required: Graphics Adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#3636)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3637) IBM T541H /L150p 15" TFT Color Monitor

(No Longer Available as of June 16, 2006)

Both the T541H and L150p monitors have the following general characteristics:

  • Business Black color
  • 15-inch TFT LCD digital screen with a viewable image size of 381 mm (15.0 inches) measured diagonally, incorporating a 0.297 mm pixel pitch/type for bright, high-definition images.
  • Designed to provide flicker free operation at a maximum resolution of 1024 x 768 pels at 75Hz in analog mode and 1024 x 768 pels at 60Hz in digital mode.
  • Tilt/swivel stand
  • Supports 2D Graphics Adapters only
  • Attributes provided: Color Flat-panel Monitor
  • Attributes required: 2D Graphics Adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#3637)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3638) IBM C220p 21-inch Color Monitor, Business Black, and Cable

(No Longer Available as of July 29, 2005)

The IBM C220p monitor has the following general characteristics:

  • Business black color
  • 21.0-inch Flat Aperture Grille CRT with a viewable image size of 508 mm (20.0 inches) measured diagonally, incorporating a 0.248 mm pixel pitch for bright, high-definition images.
  • Designed to provide reduced flicker operation at an optimum and maximum supported addressability of 1600 x 1200 pels at up to 85 Hz (Vesa) non-interlaced. Capable of 2048 x 1636 at 75 Hz (Vesa).
  • Tilt/swivel stand
  • Dual input allows attachment to two systems concurrently.
  • Depth: 483.6 mm (19.0 in.)
  • Height: 516.4 mm (20.3 in.)
  • Width: 512.8 mm (20.2 in.)
  • Weight: 30.5 kg (67.2 lbs.)
  • Attributes provided: Color Monitor
  • Attributes required: Graphics Adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#3638)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3639) IBM ThinkVision L170p Flat Panel Monitor

(No Longer Available as of September 30, 2005)

The IBM ThinkVision L170p LCD flat-panel monitor has the following general characteristics:

  • Business black color
  • 17.0-inch LCD digital screen with a viewable image size of 432 mm (17.0 inches) measured diagonally, incorporating a 0.264mm pixel pitch/type for bright, high-definition images.
  • Maximum resolution of 1280 x 1024.
  • Tilt/swivel and height adjustable stand
  • Analog or digital connection
  • Dual input allows attachment to two systems concurrently.
  • Internal power
  • Depth: 237.0 mm (9.3 in.)
  • Height: 457.0 mm (18.0 in.)
  • Width: 400.0 mm (15.7 in.)
  • Weight: 5.7 kg (12.6 lbs.)
  • Viewing angle: Vertical 170 degrees; horizontal 170 degrees
  • Contrast ratio: 500:1 (typical)
  • Video inputs: 15-pin D / DVI-D
  • Two removable cables: one analog and one digital
  • Attributes provided: Color Flat-panel Monitor
  • Attributes required: Graphics Adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#3639)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3640) - IBM ThinkVision L171p Flat Panel Monitor

(No Longer Available as of June 16, 2006)

The IBM ThinkVision L171p LCD flat-panel monitor has the following general characteristics:

  • Business black color
  • 17.0-inch LCD digital screen with a viewable image size of 432 mm (17.0 inches) measured diagonally, incorporating a 0.280mm pixel pitch/type for bright, high-definition images.
  • Maximum resolution of 1280 x 1024.
  • Tilt/swivel and height adjustable stand
  • Analog or digital connection
  • Dual input allows attachment to two systems concurrently.
  • Internal power
  • Depth: 237.0 mm (9.3 in.)
  • Height: 457.0 mm (18.0 in.)
  • Width: 400.0 mm (15.7 in.)
  • Weight: 5.7 kg (12.6 lbs.)
  • Viewing angle: Vertical +/-75 degrees; horizontal +/-75 degrees
  • Contrast ratio: 500:1 (minimal) 700:1 (typical)
  • Video inputs: 15-pin D / DVI-D
  • Two removable cables: one analog and one digital
  • Attributes provided: Color Flat-panel Monitor
  • Attributes required: Graphics Adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#3640)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3641) - IBM T115 Flat Panel Monitor

(No Longer Available as of September 10, 2007)

The IBM T115 LCD flat-panel monitor has the following general characteristics:

  • Business black color
  • 15.0-inch LCD digital screen with a viewable image size of 381 mm (15.0 inches) measured diagonally, incorporating a 0.297mm pixel pitch/type for bright, high-definition images.
  • Maximum resolution of 1024 x 768 (XGA)
  • Tilt adjustable stand
  • Analog connection
  • Internal power
  • Depth (w/stand): 144 mm (6.67 inches)
  • Height (max w/stand): 361 mm (14.2 inches
  • Width: 362 mm (14.2 inches)
  • Weight: 2.9 kg (6.4 lbs)
  • Contrast ratio: 400:1 (typical)
  • Brightness: 250cd/m2 (typical)
  • Viewing angles (H/V): 130 degrees/100 degrees
  • For 9113-550: (#3641)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3642) - ThinkVision L191p Flat Panel Monitor

(No Longer Available as of June 16, 2006)

The ThinkVision L191p LCD flat-panel monitor has the following general characteristics:

  • Business black color
  • 19.0-inch LCD digital screen with a viewable image size of 483 mm (19.0 inches) measured diagonally, incorporating a 0.294mm pixel pitch/type for bright, high-definition images.
  • Maximum resolution of 1280 x 1024.
  • Tilt/swivel and height adjustable stand
  • Analog or digital connection
  • Dual input allows attachment to two systems concurrently.
  • Internal power
  • Depth: 237.0 mm (9.3 in.)
  • Height: 457.0 mm (18.0 in.)
  • Width: 408.0 mm (16.1 in.)
  • Weight: 7.1 kg (15.7 lbs.)
  • Contrast ratio: 1000:1 (typical)
  • Video inputs: 15-pin D / DVI-D
  • Two removable cables, one analog and one digital
  • Attributes provided: Color Flat-panel Monitor
  • Attributes required: Graphics Adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#3642)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3643) - IBM T120 Flat Panel Monitor

(No longer available as of January 25, 2008)

The IBM T120 LCD flat-panel monitor has the following general characteristics:

  • Business black color
  • 20.1-inch LCD digital screen with a viewable image size of 511 mm (20.1 inches) measured diagonally, incorporating a 0.255 mm pixel pitch/type for bright, high-definition images.
  • Maximum resolution of 1600 x 1200 (UXGA)
  • Tilt/lift adjustable stand
  • Analog and digital connections
  • Internal power
  • Depth (w/stand): 246 mm (9.7 inches)
  • Height (max w/stand): 416.6 mm (16.5 inches)
  • Width: 445.6 mm (17.5 inches)
  • Weight: 7.5 kg (16.5 lbs)
  • Contrast ratio: 700:1 (typical)
  • Brightness:300cd/m2 (typical)
  • Viewing angles(H/V): 178 degrees/178 degrees
  • Video inputs: 15-pin D / DVI-D
  • Two removable cables, one analog and one digital
  • Attributes provided: Color Flat-panel Monitor
  • Attributes required: Graphics Adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#3643)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3644) - IBM T119 Flat Panel Monitor

(No Longer Available as of July 31, 2009)

The IBM T119 LCD flat-panel monitor has the following general characteristics:

  • Business black color
  • 19.0-inch LCD digital screen with a viewable image size of 483 mm (19.0 inches) measured diagonally, incorporating a 0.294 mm pixel pitch/type for bright, high-definition images.
  • Maximum resolution of 1280 x 1024 (SXGA)
  • Tilt/lift adjustable stand
  • Analog and digital connections
  • Internal power
  • Depth (w/stand): 246 mm (9.7 inches)
  • Height (max w/stand): 443.6 mm (17.5 inches)
  • Width: 418 mm (16.5 inches)
  • Weight: 7.4 kg (16.3 lbs)
  • Contrast ratio: 550:1 (typical)
  • Brightness:250cd/m2 (typical)
  • Viewing angles (H/V): 140 degrees/135 degrees
  • Video inputs: 15-pin D / DVI-D
  • Two removable cables, one analog and one digital
  • Attributes provided: Color Flat-panel Monitor
  • Attributes required: Graphics Adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#3644)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3645) - IBM T117 Flat Panel Monitor

(No Longer Available as of July 31, 2009)

The IBM T117 LCD flat-panel monitor has the following general characteristics:

  • Business black color
  • 17.0-inch LCD digital screen with a viewable image size of 432 mm (17.0 inches) measured diagonally, incorporating a 0.264 mm pixel pitch/type for bright, high-definition images.
  • Maximum resolution of 1280 x 1024 (SXGA)
  • Tilt/lift adjustable stand
  • Analog and digital connections
  • Internal power
  • Depth (w/stand): 246 mm (9.7 inches)
  • Height (max w/stand): 395.5 mm (15.6 inches)
  • Width: 375.4 mm (14.8 inches)
  • Weight: 5.8 kg (12.8 lbs)
  • Contrast ratio: 500:1 (typical)
  • Brightness: 300cd/m2 (typical)
  • Viewing angles (H/V): 140 degrees/130 degrees
  • Video inputs: 15-pin D / DVI-D
  • Two removable cables, one analog and one digital
  • Attributes provided: Color Flat-panel Monitor
  • Attributes required: Graphics Adapter
  • For 9113-550: (#3645)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3647) 146GB 15K RPM SAS Disk Drive

(No Longer Available as of February 8, 2013)

146.8GB Serial Attached SCSI (SAS) DASD device, in a carrier capable of providing Hot Swap support. Provides 146.8GB of storage capacity. Supports the industry standard SAS SCSI interface. Can be used only in a drawer/system designed to support the SAS SCSI interface.

Characteristics:

  • Form Factor: 3.5 inch Form Factor, 1 inch drive.
  • Cable included: No
  • External Interface: standard SAS Dual Port
  • Rotational Speed: 15,000 RPM
  • Interface Speed: 300 MB/sec.
  • Format: 512 Bytes/sector default, 528 Bytes/sector possible with reformat.
  • Attributes provided: 146.8GB of Disk Storage mounted in a carrier
  • Attributes required: one SAS Drive Slot
  • For 9113-550: (#3647)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 288 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required:
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-07 Technology Level and Service Pack 9, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-08 Technology Level and Service Pack 7, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-09 Technology Level and Service Pack 4, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-10 Technology Level, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-00 Technology Level and Service Pack 9, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-01 Technology Level and Service Pack 5, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-02 Technology Level and Service Pack 4, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-03 Technology Level, or later.
      • IBM i - not supported
      • SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 10, Service Pack 2 or later
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux version 4.7 or later
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux version 5.2 or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3648) 300GB 15K RPM SAS Disk Drive

(No Longer Available as of February 8, 2013)

300GB Serial Attached SCSI (SAS) DASD device, in a carrier capable of providing Hot Swap support. Provides 300GB of storage capacity. Supports the industry standard SAS SCSI interface. Can be used only in a drawer/system designed to support the SAS SCSI interface.

Characteristics:

  • Form Factor: 3.5 inch Form Factor, 1 inch drive.
  • Cable included: No
  • External Interface: standard SAS Dual Port
  • Rotational Speed: 15,000 RPM
  • Interface Speed: 300 MB/sec.
  • Format: 512 Bytes/sector default, 528 Bytes/sector possible with reformat.
  • Attributes provided: 300GB of Disk Storage mounted in a carrier
  • Attributes required: one SAS Drive Slot
  • For 9113-550: (#3648)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 288 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required:
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-07 Technology Level and Service Pack 9, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-08 Technology Level and Service Pack 7, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-09 Technology Level and Service Pack 4, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-10 Technology Level, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-00 Technology Level and Service Pack 9, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-01 Technology Level and Service Pack 5, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-02 Technology Level and Service Pack 4, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-03 Technology Level, or later.
      • IBM i - not supported
      • SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 10, Service Pack 2 or later
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux version 4.7 or later
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux version 5.2 or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3649) 450GB 15K RPM SAS Disk Drive

(No Longer Available as of February 8, 2013)

Attached SAS DASD device, in a carrier capable of providing Hot Swap support. Provides 450GB of storage capacity. Supports the industry standard SAS interface. Can be used only in a drawer/system designed to support the SAS interface.

Characteristics:

  • Form Factor: 3.5 inch Form Factor, 1 inch drive.
  • Cable included: No
  • External Interface: standard SAS Dual Port
  • Rotational Speed: 15,000 RPM
  • Interface Speed: 300 MB/sec.
  • Format: 512 Bytes/sector default, 528 Bytes/sector possible with re- format.
  • Attributes provided: 450GB of disk storage mounted in a carrier.
  • Attributes required: one SAS disk drive bay
  • For 9113-550: (#3649)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 288 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required:
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-07 Technology Level and Service Pack 9, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-08 Technology Level and Service Pack 7, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-09 Technology Level and Service Pack 4, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-10 Technology Level, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-00 Technology Level and Service Pack 9, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-01 Technology Level and Service Pack 5, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-02 Technology Level and Service Pack 4, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-03 Technology Level, or later.
      • IBM i - not supported
      • SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 10, Service Pack 2 or later
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux version 4.7 or later
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux version 5.2 or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3652) SAS Cable (EE) Drawer to Drawer 1M

SAS Cable (EE), connects a second SAS disk drawer to a primary SAS disk drawer attached to a SAS controller adapter. This cable has one Mini SAS 4x cable plug connector on each end. Both connectors must be attached to an ENCLOSURE UP Arrow port on the ESM module of the attaching drawers. Follow the directions on the connector labels when attaching the connectors on this cable. This cable supports both Single and Dual path configurations. All supported configurations require two of this feature to attach a secondary disk drawer to the primary disk drawer. The length of this cable is 1 meter. Choose the SAS (EE) cable length to match the distance between the two SAS drawers.

  • Attributes provided: SAS Disk drawer to SAS Disk drawer attach cable
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#3652)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: no max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: none
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3653) SAS Cable (EE) Drawer to Drawer 3M

SAS Cable (EE), connects a second SAS disk drawer to a primary SAS disk drawer attached to a SAS controller adapter. This cable has one Mini SAS 4x cable plug connector on each end. Both connectors must be attached to an ENCLOSURE UP Arrow port on the ESM module of the attaching drawers. Follow the directions on the connector labels when attaching the connectors on this cable. This cable supports both Single and Dual path configurations. All supported configurations require two of this feature to attach a secondary disk drawer to the primary disk drawer. The length of this cable is 3 meter. Choose the SAS (EE) cable length to match the distance between the two SAS drawers.

  • Attributes provided: SAS Disk drawer to SAS Disk drawer attach cable
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#3653)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: no max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: none
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3654) SAS Cable (EE) Drawer to Drawer 6M

SAS Cable (EE), connects a second SAS disk drawer to a primary SAS disk drawer attached to a SAS controller adapter. This cable has one Mini SAS 4x cable plug connector on each end. Both connectors must be attached to an ENCLOSURE UP Arrow port on the ESM module of the attaching drawers. Follow the directions on the connector labels when attaching the connectors on this cable. This cable supports both Single and Dual path configurations. All supported configurations require two of this feature to attach a secondary disk drawer to the primary disk drawer. The length of this cable is 6 meter. Choose the SAS (EE) cable length to match the distance between the two SAS drawers.

  • Attributes provided: SAS Disk drawer to SAS Disk drawer attach cable
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#3654)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: no max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: none
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3661) SAS Cable (X) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Dual Controller/Dual Path 3M

This SAS cable (X) connects a SAS disk drawer to two SAS controller adapters. This cable supports dual controller/dual path attach between two SAS controller adapters and the SAS disk drawer. The SAS controller adapters can be in the same or in different host systems. This cable has four Mini SAS 4x plug connectors. Two of the Mini SAS 4x plug connectors attach to the adapters and are keyed as END DEVICES. Two of the Mini SAS 4x plug connectors attach to the SAS disk drawer and are keyed for ENCLOSURE DOWN Arrow. All of the connectors are wired in 2x mode. Follow the directions on the connector labels when attaching the connectors on this cable. This cable is 3 meters long, choose the SAS (X) cable length that matches the distance between the adapters and the SAS disk drawer. The adapter legs of this cable are each 2.5 meters long.

  • Attributes provided: connection between two SAS controller adapters and a SAS disk drawer
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#3661)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: no max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: none
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3662) SAS Cable (X) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Dual Controller/Dual Path 6M

This SAS cable (X) connects a SAS disk drawer to two SAS controller adapters. This cable supports dual controller/dual path attach between two SAS controller adapters and the SAS disk drawer. The SAS controller adapters can be in the same or in different host systems. This cable has four Mini SAS 4x plug connectors. Two of the Mini SAS 4x plug connectors attach to the adapters and are keyed as END DEVICES. Two of the Mini SAS 4x plug connectors attach to the SAS disk drawer and are keyed for ENCLOSURE DOWN Arrow. All of the connectors are wired in 2x mode. Follow the directions on the connector labels when attaching the connectors on this cable. This cable is 6 meters long, choose the SAS (X) cable length that matches the distance between the adapters and the SAS disk drawer. The adapter legs of this cable are each 5.5 meters long.

  • Attributes provided: connection between two SAS controller adapters and a SAS disk drawer
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#3662)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: no max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: none
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3663) SAS Cable (X) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Dual Controller/Dual Path 15M

This SAS cable (X) connects a SAS disk drawer to two SAS controller adapters. This cable supports dual controller/dual path attach between two SAS controller adapters and the SAS disk drawer. The SAS controller adapters can be in the same or in different host systems. This cable has four Mini SAS 4x plug connectors. Two of the Mini SAS 4x plug connectors attach to the adapters and are keyed as END DEVICES. Two of the Mini SAS 4x plug connectors attach to the SAS disk drawer and are keyed for ENCLOSURE DOWN Arrow. All of the connectors are wired in 2x mode. Follow the directions on the connector labels when attaching the connectors on this cable. This cable is 15 meters long, choose the SAS (X) cable length that matches the distance between the adapters and the SAS disk drawer. The adapter legs of this cable are each 14.5 meters long.

  • Attributes provided: connection between two SAS controller adapters and a SAS disk drawer
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#3663)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: no max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: none
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3684) SAS Cable (AE) Adapter to Enclosure, single controller/single path 3M

This adapter-to-enclosure (AE) SAS cable most commonly connects a SAS controller to a media expansion drawer.

For AIX and Linux, this cable can also be used to connect two SAS adapters to a SAS disk drawer in a specific dual controller HA two system JBOD configuration using two #5912 controllers. Single controller/single path connections are supported with this cable only for this specific JBOD configuration, and, as such, two #5912 SAS controllers and two (AE style) cables are required for a supported configuration. The two SAS adapters must be in different host systems/partitions.

This cable has one mini SAS 4X plug connector on the adapter end wired in 4x mode and one mini SAS 4X plug connector on the drawer end, wired in 4x mode. Follow the directions on the connector labels when attaching the connectors on this cable. This cable is three meters long. Select the SAS (AE) cable length that best matches the distance between the host system and the remote SAS drawer being attached.

  • Attributes provided: Connection between a SAS controller and a media expansion drawer or for AIX and Linux connection between #5912 SAS controller and a SAS disk drawer in a dual controller HA two system JBOD configuration only
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#3684)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: no max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: none
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3685) SAS Cable (AE) Adapter to Enclosure, single controller/single path 6M

This adapter-to-enclosure (AE) SAS cable most commonly connects a SAS controller to a media expansion drawer.

For the AIX and Linux operating systems, this cable can also be used to connect two SAS adapters to a SAS disk drawer in a specific dual controller HA two system JBOD configuration using two #5912 controllers. Single controller/single path connections are supported with this cable only for this specific JBOD configuration, and, as such, two #5912 SAS controllers and two (AE style) cables are required for a supported configuration. The two SAS adapters must be in different host systems/partitions.

This cable has one mini SAS 4X plug connector on the adapter end wired in 4x mode and one mini SAS 4X plug connector on the drawer end, wired in 4x mode. Follow the directions on the connector labels when attaching the connectors on this cable. This cable is three meters long. Select the SAS (AE) cable length that best matches the distance between the host system and the remote SAS drawer being attached.

  • Attributes provided: Connection between a SAS controller and a media expansion drawer or for AIX and Linux connection between #5912 SAS controller and a SAS disk drawer in a dual controller HA two system JBOD configuration only
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#3685)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: no max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: none
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3691) SAS Cable (YO) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Single Controller/Dual Path 1.5 M

This SAS cable (YO) connects a remote SAS drawer to a SAS controller adapter. This cable supports single controller/dual path attach between the SAS controller adapter and the SAS disk drawer. This cable has one Mini SAS 4X plug connector on the adapter end keyed for an END DEVICE, wired in 4x mode and two Mini SAS 4X plug connectors on the drawer end keyed for ENCLOSURE DOWN Arrow, both are wired in 2x mode. Follow the directions on the connector labels when attaching the connectors on this cable. This cable is 1.5 meters long, choose the SAS (YO) cable length that matches the distance between the adapter and the SAS disk drawer.

  • Attributes provided: connection between SAS controller adapter and a SAS disk drawer
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#3691)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: no max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: none
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3692) SAS Cable (YO) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Single Controller/Dual Path 3 M

This SAS cable (YO) connects a remote SAS drawer to a SAS controller adapter. This cable supports single controller/dual path attach between the SAS controller adapter and the SAS disk drawer. This cable has one Mini SAS 4X plug connector on the adapter end keyed for an END DEVICE, wired in 4x mode and two Mini SAS 4X plug connectors on the drawer end keyed for ENCLOSURE DOWN Arrow, both are wired in 2x mode. Follow the directions on the connector labels when attaching the connectors on this cable. This cable is 3 meters long, choose the SAS (YO) cable length that matches the distance between the adapter and the SAS disk drawer.

  • Attributes provided: connection between SAS controller adapter and a SAS disk drawer
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#3692)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: no max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: none
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3693) SAS Cable (YO) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Single Controller/Dual Path 6 M

This SAS cable (YO) connects a remote SAS drawer to a SAS controller adapter. This cable supports single controller/dual path attach between the SAS controller adapter and the SAS disk drawer. This cable has one Mini SAS 4X plug connector on the adapter end keyed for an END DEVICE, wired in 4x mode and two Mini SAS 4X plug connectors on the drawer end keyed for ENCLOSURE DOWN Arrow, both are wired in 2x mode. Follow the directions on the connector labels when attaching the connectors on this cable. This cable is 6 meters long, choose the SAS (YO) cable length that matches the distance between the adapter and the SAS disk drawer.

  • Attributes provided: connection between SAS controller adapter and a SAS disk drawer
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#3693)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: no max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: none
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3694) SAS Cable (YO) Adapter to SAS Enclosure, Single Controller/Dual Path 15 M

This SAS cable (YO) connects a remote SAS drawer to a SAS controller adapter. This cable supports single controller/dual path attach between the SAS controller adapter and the SAS disk drawer. This cable has one Mini SAS 4X plug connector on the adapter end keyed for an END DEVICE, wired in 4x mode and two Mini SAS 4X plug connectors on the drawer end keyed for ENCLOSURE DOWN Arrow, both are wired in 2x mode. Follow the directions on the connector labels when attaching the connectors on this cable. This cable is 15 meters long, choose the SAS (YO) cable length that matches the distance between the adapter and the SAS disk drawer.

  • Attributes provided: connection between SAS controller adapter and a SAS disk drawer
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#3694)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: no max (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: none
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3752) Service Package

(No Longer Available as of January 7, 2011)

This kit contains publications, wrap plugs, and diagnostic CD-ROM. The "Diagnostics Information for Multiple Bus Systems" contains information common to all multiple bus system units and is used primarily for problem isolation by a customer's service specialist trained on the unit being serviced.

These publications are intended to be used in the customer's enterprise by the customer's own service specialists, and not by IBM Service personnel.

Two wrap plugs are included for use in diagnostic testing of the following connections to the system unit:

  • RS-232 serial I/O port
  • parallel I/O port

This kit also contains system diagnostic CD-ROM, along with a test diskette, for use by the customer's service specialist (not by IBM Service personnel).

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#3752)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3925) Serial Port Converter Cable, 9-Pin to 25-Pin

This cable converts the 9-pin serial port on the system to a 25-pin serial port which allows the user to attach 25-pin serial devices to the system.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#3925)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3926) Asynch Printer/Terminal Cable, 9-pin to 25-pin, 4M

(No Longer Available as of July 29, 2011)

This 4-meter cable and transposer (2 parts) allows external async devices such as printers or terminals to be attached directly to the 9-pin serial port. This is equivalent to using #3925 in combination with #2934.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#3926)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 3 (Initial order maximum: 3)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.1 or AIX 5.2, or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#3927) Serial Port Null Modem Cable, 9-pin to 9-pin, 3.7M

This 3.7 meter 9 pin to 9 pin Null modem Serial cable allows two EIA-232 communications ports to exchange data with one another without going through a modem.

  • Attributes provided: 9 pin female connector at each end of the cable
  • For 9113-550: (#3927)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 99 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: n/a
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#3928) Serial Port Null Modem Cable, 9-pin to 9-pin, 10M

This 10 meter 9 pin to 9 pin Null Modem Serial cable allows two EIA-232 communications ports to exchange data with one another without going through a modem.

  • Attributes provided: 9 pin female connector at each end of the cable
  • For 9113-550: (#3928)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 99 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: n/a
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4242) 6 Foot Extender Cable for Displays (15 pin D-shell to 15 pin D-shell)

This cable is required to connect displays with a 15-pin "D" shell connector to the appropriate accelerator connector when it is farther away than the attached monitor cable can reach. Rack mounted systems are likely candidates for this extender cable.

  • Attributes provided: 6-foot extension cable
  • Attributes required: Supported monitor and adapter with a 15-pin "D" shell connector.
  • For 9113-550: (#4242)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4256) Extender Cable - USB Keyboards, 2M

This feature provides a 2M extension cable for use with USB keyboards.

  • Attributes provided: 2M Extension Cable
  • Attributes required: USB Keyboard
  • For 9113-550: (#4256)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4263) SCSI Cables (Power and Logic), PCI Riser to SCSI LVD Media Device; Mounting Tray

(No Longer Available as of January 4, 2010)

This feature number provides a SCSI LVD logic and power cable that connects the SCSI controller on the system planar to the SCSI media bay. Required when installing a SCSI LVD device in the SCSI media bay. Also includes a mounting tray for the SCSI LVD media device.

  • Attributes provided: Connection between SCSI controller and the SCSI media bay. Mounting tray.
  • Attributes required: SCSI LVD device in SCSI media bay.
  • For 9113-550: (#4263)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4267) SCSI Cable, PCI Adapter to Hot-Swap Disks

(No Longer Available as of November 15, 2004.)

SCSI cable that connects a PCI adapter to the hot swap disks.

  • Attributes provided: Connection between adapter and hot swap disk drives.
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#4267)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4273) External SCSI Port Enablement Cable

(No Longer Available as of January 4, 2010)

SCSI cable that connects one SCSI internal controller to an external port allowing attachment of external SCSI devices to the system. Installing this feature in the system will negate the usage of a second four-pack disk enclosure (second #6592 or first pp#6593), and uses 1 slot.

  • Attributes provided: External SCSI port
  • Attributes required: One internal SCSI controller and 1 PCI slot
  • For 9113-550: (#4273)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4274) SCSI Cable, PCI Adapter to Hot-Swap Disks

(No Longer Available as of January 4, 2010)

SCSI cable that connects a PCI adapter to the hot swap disks.

  • Attributes provided: Connection between adapter and hot swap disk drives
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#4274)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Minimum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4353) H-100 Bus 8-position Cable

(No Longer Available as of December 10, 2004)

This cable provides the capability to interconnect adapters that provide H.100 bus connectors. This 8-position cable should be used when more than four and less than or equal to eight adapters with H.100 connectors will be interconnected. If four or less adapters are interconnected, the H.100 Bus 4-Drop Cable (#2877) should be used.

  • Attributes provided: H.100 bus connection between adapters
  • Attributes required: Four to eight H.100 adapters
  • For 9113-550: (#4353)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: No
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4443) 512MB (2x256MB) DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR SDRAM

(No longer available as of August 29, 2008)

Provides 512MB of system memory with 2 x 256 MB DIMMs.

  • Attributes provided: 512MB of system memory.
  • Attributes required: Two empty memory DIMM positions.
  • For 9113-550: (#4443)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3. or later. For Linux, refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: #4443 is only available with #5239. Whenever more DIMMs are added to a system with #5239, an additional pair of #4443 must be added to the original pair to make a quad, then one additional quad of DIMMs may be added to the system.

(#4444) 1024MB (4X256MB) DIMMS, 208-PIN, 266 MHZ DDR SDRAM

(No Longer Available as of December 12, 2008)

Provides 1024MB of system memory with 4 256MB DIMMs.

  • Attributes provided: 1024MB of system memory.
  • Attributes required: Four empty memory DIMM positions.
  • For 9113-550: (#4444)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatureshtml
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4445) 4096MB (4X1024MB) DIMMS, 208-PIN, 266 MHZ DDR SDRAM

(No Longer Available as of December 12, 2008)

Provides 4096MB of system memory with 4 1024MB DIMMs.

  • Attributes provided: 4096MB of system memory.
  • Attributes required: Four empty memory DIMM positions.
  • For 9113-550: (#4445)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatureshtml
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4447) 2048MB (4X512MB) DIMMS, 208-PIN, 266 MHZ DDR SDRAM

(No Longer Available as of December 12, 2008)

Provides 2048MB of system memory with 4 512MB DIMMs.

  • Attributes provided: 2048MB of system memory.
  • Attributes required: Four empty memory DIMM positions.
  • For 9113-550: (#4447)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatureshtml
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4449) 8192MB (4x2048MB) DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR Stacked SDRAM

(No Longer Available as of January 4, 2010)

Provides 8192MB of system memory with 4 2048MB DIMMs.

  • Attributes provided: 8192MB of system memory.
  • Attributes required: Four empty memory DIMM positions.
  • For 9113-550: (#4449)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4450) 16GB (4x4096MB) DIMMs, 208-pin, 266 MHz DDR Stacked SDRAM

(No Longer Available as of December 12, 2008)

Provides 16GB of system memory with 4 4096MB DIMMs.

  • Attributes provided: 16GB of system memory.
  • Attributes required: Four empty memory DIMM positions.
  • For 9113-550: (#4450)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4650) - Rack Indicator- Not Factory Integrated

This indicator is used to specify that the rack-mountable device in this initial order should not be merged into a rack within IBM Manufacturing.

Note: This "no charge" feature will be placed on an initial order for a rack-mountable device by the Configuration Tool when the order does not include a 19" Rack.

Note: A rack integration indicator is required on all 19" Rack mountable device initial orders. One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

  • Attributes provided: System will not be shipped in a rack.
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#4650)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1 )
    • OS level required: n/a
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: N/A
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4651) - Rack Indicator, Rack #1

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the first rack for a multi-rack order, or the only rack for a single rack order. When added to an initial rack-mountable device order this indicator is used to specify that the rack-mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #1 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Manufacturing.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4651)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1 )
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4652) - Rack Indicator, Rack #2

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the second rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack- mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack- mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #2 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Manufacturing.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4652)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1 )
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4653) - Rack Indicator, Rack #3

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the third rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack- mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack- mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #3 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4653)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4654) - Rack Indicator, Rack #4

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the fourth rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack- mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack- mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #4 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4654)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4655) - Rack Indicator, Rack #5

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the fifth rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack- mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack- mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #5 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4655)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4656) - Rack Indicator, Rack #6

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the sixth rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack- mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack- mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #6 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4656)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4657) - Rack Indicator, Rack #7

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the seventh rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack- mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack- mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #7 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4657)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4658) - Rack Indicator, Rack #8

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the eighth rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack- mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack- mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #8 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4658)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4659) - Rack Indicator, Rack #9

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the ninth rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack- mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack- mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #9 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4659)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4660) - Rack Indicator, Rack #10

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the tenth rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack- mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack- mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #10 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4660)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4661) - Rack Indicator, Rack #11

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the eleventh rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack- mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack- mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #11 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4661)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4662) - Rack Indicator, Rack #12

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the twelfth rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack- mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack- mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #12 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4662)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4663) - Rack Indicator, Rack #13

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the thirteenth rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack-mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack-mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #13 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4663)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4664) - Rack Indicator, Rack #14

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the fourteenth rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack-mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack-mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #14 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4664)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4665) - Rack Indicator, Rack #15

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the fifteenth rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack-mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack-mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #15 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4665)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4666) - Rack Indicator, Rack #16

When added to an initial rack order, this indicator is used to specify the sixteenth rack for a multi-rack order. When added to an initial rack-mountable device order, this indicator is used to specify that the rack-mountable device (such as a system or I/O drawer) is to be mounted in rack #16 of a multi-rack order.

Note: For 19" rack-mountable device orders: One feature code from the group 4650 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code from this group is not allowed.

For 19" rack orders: One feature code selection from the group 4651 to 4666 must be listed on the order. More than one feature code selection from this group is not allowed. The quantity of this selected feature code on the 19" rack order must equal the number of rack- mountable devices to be installed in the rack by IBM Mfg.

  • Attributes provided: Rack specify
  • Attributes required: Rack
  • For 9113-550: (#4666)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#4691) Rack Status Beacon Cable, Junction Box To Drawer Or Status Beacon

(No Longer Available as of November 18, 2005)

This cable can be used to connect the Rack Status Beacon Junction Box to a supported rack drawer or to the Rack Status Beacon.

  • Attributes provided: Connection between Rack Status Beacon components
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#4691)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4693) Rack Status Beacon Junction Box

(No Longer Available as of November 18, 2005)

This feature provides six input connectors and one output connector for racks configured with the Rack Status Beacon (#4690). Multiple Junction Boxes can be linked together in series with Daisy Chain Cable #4692.

  • Attributes provided: Connection of multiple drawers to a single Rack Status Beacon (#4690).
  • Attributes required: Feature #4690 and two or more #4691 cables.
  • For 9113-550: (#4693)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4764) PCI-X Cryptographic Coprocessor (FIPS 4)

(No Longer Available as of July 29, 2011)

Provides both cryptographic coprocessor and secure-key cryptographic accelerator functions in a single PCI-X card. The coprocessor functions are targeted to banking and finance applications. Financial PIN processing and Europay, MasterCard, Visa (EMV) credit card functions are provided. EMV is a standard for integrated-chip based credit cards. The secure-key accelerator functions are targeted to improving the performance of Secure Sockets Layer (SSL) transactions. The #4764 provides the security and performance required to support eBusiness and emerging digital signature applications. Host application access to the cryptographic services of the #4764 are via the Common Cryptographic Architecture (CCA) application programming interfaces (APIs) or additionally (as of 3/30/2007) via Public-Key Cryptographic Standards (PKCS#11) APIs. Only one API can be loaded on a single feature 4764 card.

The #4764 provides secure storage of cryptographic keys in a tamper-resistant hardware security module (HSM), which is designed to meet FIPS 140 security requirements. FIPS 140 is a U.S. Government National Institute of Standards & Technology (NIST) administered standard and certification program for cryptographic modules. The firmware for the #4764 is shipped on a CD that is part of the feature. Software installation documentation is shipped on the same CD.

Note: Prior to 3/30/2007 only CCA was supported (available on CD LCD8-0477-00). Customers installing feature 4764 prior to 3/30/2007 who now wish to install PKCS#11 can contact 1-800-IBM-SERV to request ECA 618 for use with feature 4764. Only one API can be loaded on a single feature 4764 card. Customers currently running with CCA support do not need this ECA as there is no newer version of the CCA function on this new CD

  • Attributes provided: Cryptographic Accelerator Function, EMV-Based Credit Card Function, CCA API Host Support and (as of 3/30/2007) PKCS#11 API. Both CCA APIs and PKCS#11 APIs are included on CD LCD8-0477-01, titled "4764 PCI-X Cryptographic Coprocessor Support Version 2.0". li.Attributes required: One PCI-X card slot Note: Only one API (CCA or PKCS11 but not both) can be loaded per 4764 Feature.
  • For 9113-550: (#4764)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 5 (Initial order maximum: 5)
    • OS level required: AIX 5L for POWER V5.2 with the 5200-09 Technology Level (APAR IY82425), or later or AIX 5L for POWER V5.3 with the 5300-05 Technology Level (APAR IY82426), or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

    Note: Please validate that software components which provide SSL are enabled to use hardware cryptographic devices through the PKCS#11 or CCA API's. If assistance is needed in determining if the device will meet your needs please contact crypto@us.ibm.com.

    Note: Max per cpu is 2; 8 per IO drawer/partition/planar.

(#4959) IBM Token-Ring PCI Adapter

(No Longer Available as of March 31, 2006)

The IBM Token-Ring PCI Adapter for RS/6000 is a single slot, short, 32-bit, PCI adapter supporting 4 or 16 Mbps data rates, either half-duplex or full-duplex.

Automatic Ring-Speed selection prevents "wrong speed" insertion into the ring, even when connected to speed-sensing hubs. This adapter will operate with either unshielded twisted pair (UTP) Cat 5 cable with RJ-45 connectors or shielded twisted pair (STP) Type 1A cabling with 9-pin D-shell connectors. The Token-Ring PCI Adapter will provide network boot capability.

  • Attributes provided:
  • Attributes required: A single empty 32-bit PCI adapter slot.
  • For 9113-550: (#4959)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#4962) 10/100 Mbps Ethernet PCI Adapter II

(No Longer Available as of March 31, 2006)

The 10/100 Mbps Ethernet PCI Adapter II is a small form factor, single port PCI ethernet adapter. This high performance, low power ethernet 10/100Mbps LAN adapter can be used in both client and server PCI systems. The 10/100 Mbps Ethernet PCI Adapter II provides both 10Base-T and 100Base-TX full duplex ethernet LAN connectivity. The adapter supports Category-5 unshielded twisted pair cabling for both 10/100 Mbps and Category-3 unshielded twisted pair cabling for 10 Mbps. The 10/100 Mbps Ethernet PCI Adapter II supports:

  • Half / Full Duplex 10/100 Mbps Ethernet interface
  • 10/100 Mbps data rates
  • Auto-negotiation for 10/100 speed and half/full duplex
  • Network boot capability and Network Install Manager (NIM)
  • IEEE 802.3 Ethernet Specification
  • IEEE 802.3u Fast Ethernet Specification

After 4/26/02, the 10/100 Mbps Ether off-load of IP Security cryptographic algorithms by providing hardware assistance in performing data encryption and authentication. This support is provided with AIX 5.1 (with appropriate software updates)and later software. This IP Security function, normally performed with encryption software by the host, is off-loaded to this adapter to enhance network traffic throughput and reduce CPU utilization. If you are running with AIX 5.1, to invoke the IP Security function on the adapter, you must obtain AIX 5.1 software updates IY27069 and IY26514 or the 5100-02 Recommended Maintenance package. These updates can be obtained by ordering APAR IY28102, or by ordering the AIX 5.1 Update CD (LCD4-1103-03) dated 4/2002 or later. Note: This IP Security function is not supported with AIX 4.3 software.

An additional function called 'Large Send' or sometimes known as TCP Segmentation is also available. This function offloads the TCP segmentation operation from the AIX IP layer to the adapter for outgoing (transmit side) TCP segments. Another function known as "Checksum Offload" which offloads the TCP/UDP Checksum Operation or workload from the CPU to the adapter is also available. Both these functions are available with AIX version 5.1 with APAR IY38248 or later software, or AIX version 5.2 with APAR IY38492 or later software.

  • Attributes provided: One 10/100 Mbps Ethernet port (connector)
  • Attributes required: One PCI slot
  • For 9113-550: (#4962)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 5 (Initial order maximum: 5)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5001) Customer Service Specify

(No Longer Available as of November 27, 2009)

This feature code specifies that the system will receive special request services from the Customer Solution Center (CSC).

  • Attributes provided: Customization
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#5001)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#5005) Software Preinstall

(No Longer Available in Latin America as of March 01, 2006)

Licensed programs may be preinstalled on the media selected. To order this option, specify code (#5005) on the initial system order. The preinstalled licensed programs will be at the same release level as programs being shipped from the Program Libraries at the time the system is manufactured.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#5005)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#5237) 2-Way 1.65 GHz POWER5 CUoD Processor Card, 0-Way Active, 8 Memory DIMM Slots

(No Longer Available as of March 21, 2008)

2-way 1.65 GHz processor card with Capacity Upgrade on Demand. The two processors share 36MB of L3 cache and 1.9MB of L2 cache. There are 8 DIMM slots on the processor card which may be used without activating the processors.

  • Attributes provided: 2-way processor card, 0-way active
  • Attributes required: One processor card slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5237)
    • Minimum required: 1
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5239) 1-way 1.5 GHz POWER5 Processor Card, No L3 Cache

(No Longer Available as of March 21, 2008)

1-way processor card with 1.5 GHz POWER5 processor and no L3 cache.

  • Attributes provided: 1-way processor card, no L3 cache
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#5239)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. For Linux, refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5264) 2-way 1.5 GHz POWER5 Processor Card, 36MB L3 Cache, DDR 1 Memory DIMMs

(No Longer Available as of March 21, 2008)

2-way 1.5 GHz processor card. The two processors share 36MB of L3 cache and 1.9MB of L2 cache. There are 8 DIMM slots on the processor card.

  • Attributes provided: 2-way processor card
  • Attributes required: One processor card slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5264)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. For Linux, refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: Feature conversion only

(#5700) IBM Gigabit Ethernet-SX PCI-X Adapter

The IBM Gigabit Ethernet-SX PCI-X Adapter provides a 1 Gbps (1000 Base-SX) full-duplex Ethernet LAN connection with throughput on a standard shortwave multimode optical cable which conforms to the IEEE 802.3z standard. The adapter supports distances of 260m for 62.5 micron Multi Mode Fiber (MMF) and 550m for 50.0 micron MMF. AIX Network Install Manager (NIM) boot capability is supported with this adapter.

Note: For optimum performance, the adapter should be placed in a 64 bit PCI-X card slot.

Note: The IBM Gigabit Ethernet-SX PCI-X Adapter (#5700) incorporates an LC type connector on the card. This new, smaller form factor connector is being used by the industry for the next generation of fiber optic networks. If connecting into an older, existing SC type connector network, an LC-SC 62.5 Micron Fiber Converter Cable (#2459) or LC-SC 50 Micron Fiber Converter Cable (#2456) is required.

Limitation: Half Duplex (HDX) mode is not supported.

  • Attributes provided: One full-duplex 1000Base-SX fiber connection to a Gigabit Ethernet LAN.
  • Attributes required: One available PCI or PCI-X card slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5700)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 5 (Initial order maximum: 5)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5701) IBM 10/100/1000 Base-TX Ethernet PCI-X Adapter

The IBM 10/100/1000 Base-TX Ethernet PCI-X Adapter is a Full Duplex Gigabit Ethernet adapter designed with highly integrated components. This adapter can be configured to run at 10, 100, or 1000 Mbps data rates. The adapter interfaces to the system via the PCI-X bus and connects to the network using a 4-pair CAT-5 Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) cable for distances of up to 100m. AIX Network Install Manager (NIM) boot capability is supported with this adapter. The adapter conforms to the IEEE 802.3ab 1000Base-T standard. The adapter also supports jumbo frames when running at the 1000 Mbps speed.

Note: For optimum performance, adapter should be placed in a 64 bit PCI-X card slot.

Limitations: The 1000 Mbps speed is not supported in Half Duplex (HDX) mode.

  • Attributes provided: One full-duplex 10/100/1000Base-TX UTP connection to a Gigabit Ethernet LAN.
  • Attributes required: One available PCI or PCI-X card slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5701)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 5 (Initial order maximum: 5)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5703) PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter

(No Longer Available as of March 31, 2006)

The PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter (#5703) is a 64-bit 3.3 volt, bootable high performance Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter providing RAID 0,5, or 10 capability and can address up to thirty 16-bit SCSI physical disk drives on two independent SCSI buses.

To increase the data writing performance, a 40 MByte non-volitile fast-write cache is provided as a resident part of this adapter. The 40 MByte fast-write cache can provide a significant improvement in data throughput and response time during certain sequence write operations compared to SCSI RAID adapters without the fast-write cache. The response time and data transfer improvement will vary depending upon the data block sizes, the percentage of sequential writes, machine type/model, and application parameters.

The Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter has two independent ultra320 SCSI buses. There are two internal ports and two external ports. The two internal ports are shared with the two external ports. The SCSI busses can drive either an internal port or an external port. The internal ports can be used to provide an internal RAID solution on certain supporting pSeries systems with internal multiple disk drives or packs of drives. Internally attached Ultra320 devices are designed to run at a data rate of up to 320 MB per second on systems that have internal backplanes that are capable of supporting Ultra320 speeds.

In order to achieve an Ultra320 SCSI bus data rate of up to 320 MB per second and also maintain a reasonable drive distance, the adapter utilizes Low Voltage Differential (LVD) drivers and receivers. To fully utilize this 320 MB per second performance, all attaching devices should also be Ultra320 LVD devices. But, if Ultra2, Ultra3, or Ultra320 devices coexist on the same bus, each device will operate at its rated speed. For lower speed single-ended (SE) devices, the SCSI bus will switch to single-ended (SE) performance and interface to all devices on that SCSI bus at the lower SE bus data rate of the device.

When an array configuration is selected with the RAID Manager, the disk drives being designated as part of the array (attached to either the internal or external ports) are required to be formatted to 522 byte sectors. 522 byte sectors provide additional CRC error checking for improved data integrity. A menu option is provided in the AIX supporting software which will reformat these disk drives prior to their usage in an array. Conversely, when a disk drive is removed from an array, a similar menu option is also provided to re-format them back to 512 byte sectors. Note: Some disk drives require that their microcode be updated to the latest level before being formatted to 522 Byte Sectors. Also, there are some disk drives which do not support being formatted to 522 Byte Sectors. The PCI-X SCSI Disk Array Manager will inform the user of these known situations when they exist. For disk microcode updates, go to the following web page URL:

http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/mdownload/

Two industry standard VHDCI 68-pin connectors are mounted on the adapter's end bracket allowing attachment of various LVD and SE external subsystems. A .3 meter converter cable, VHDCI to P, Mini-68 pin to 68-pin, (#2118) can be used with older external SE devices or subsystems to allow connection to the VHDCI connector on the PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter.

The two external ports provide connectivity to an IBM 2104-DS4 Expandable Storage Plus Drawer or 2104-TS4 Expandable Storage Plus Tower at up to 320 MB/s SCSI bus data rate configured as either a non-array or an array of disks Also the two external ports provide non-array connectivity to numerous other SCSI external subsystems. Check the external subsystem sales/web pages for verification of connectivity support with this adapter.

Limitations:

  • The two external ports provide connectivity to an IBM 2104-DU3 Expandable Storage Plus Drawer or 2104-TU3 Expandable Storage Plus Tower at up to 160 MB/s SCSI bus data rate as well as connectivity to an IBM 2104-DL1 Expandable Storage Plus Drawer or 2104-TL1 Expandable Storage Plus Tower at up to 80 MB/s SCSI bus data rate, but is limited to only non-array configuration support.
  • The two external ports do not support the connection to the IBM 7131-105 IBM Multi-Storage Tower model 105.
  • Even though the Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter has ports that run at ultra320 SCSI speeds (up to 320 MBytes/s), the internally attached disk drives will run at a maximum SCSI bus data rate specified by that supporting system disk backplane.
  • Disk drives internal to the pSeries system shipped prior to September 1, 2003 require a disk drive microcode update to run at Ultra320 speed. To obtain the appropriate microcode update, go to the following web page URL:
    http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/mdownload/
  • Attributes provided: Attachment of internal and external SCSI devices
  • Attributes required: One PCI or PCI-X bus slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5703)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3 or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5706) IBM 2-Port 10/100/1000 Base-TX Ethernet PCI-X Adapter

The IBM 2-Port 10/100/1000 Base-TX Ethernet PCI-X Adapter is a Full Duplex, dual ported, Gigabit Ethernet adapter designed with highly integrated components. This adapter can be configured to run each port at 10, 100, or 1000 Mbps data rates. The adapter interfaces to the system via a PCI or PCI-X bus and connects to a network using a 4-pair CAT-5 Unshielded Twisted Pair (UTP) cable for distances of up to 100m. AIX Network Install Manager (NIM) boot capability is supported with this adapter. The adapter conforms to the IEEE 802.3ab 1000Base-T standard. The adapter also supports jumbo frames when running at the 1000 Mbps speed.

A function called 'Large Send' or sometimes known as TCP Segmentation is also provided by this adapter. This function offloads the TCP segmentation operation from the AIX IP layer to the adapter for outgoing (transmit side) TCP segments. Another function known as "Checksum Offload" which offloads the TCP/UDP Checksum Operation or workload from the CPU to the adapter is also provided.

The IBM 2-Port 10/100/1000 Base-TX Ethernet PCI-X Adapter (#5706) should be considered where maximum port density is required per I/O card slot. For a suggested maximum number of adapters taking performance into consideration, refer to the RS/6000 & pSeries PCI Adapter Placement Reference SA38-0538. If card slots are not the limiting factor and maximum throughput is required, the single port IBM 10/100/1000 Base-TX Ethernet PCI-X Adapter (#5701) is the preferred solution. Note: For optimum performance, the adapter should be placed in a 64 bit PCI-X card slot whenever possible.

Limitations: The 1000 Mbps speed is not supported in Half Duplex (HDX) mode.

  • Attributes provided: Two full-duplex 10/100/1000Base-TX UTP connections to Gigabit Ethernet LAN(s).
  • Attributes required: One available PCI or PCI-X card slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5706)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 5 (Initial order maximum: 5)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5707) IBM 2-Port Gigabit Ethernet-SX PCI-X Adapter

The IBM 2-Port Gigabit Ethernet-SX PCI-X Adapter provides two 1 Gbps (1000 Base-SX) full-duplex Ethernet LAN connections with throughput on a standard shortwave multimode optical cable that conforms to the IEEE 802.3z standard. The adapter supports distances of 260m for 62.5 micron Multi Mode Fiber (MMF) and 550m for 50.0 micron MMF. AIX Network Install Manager (NIM) boot capability is supported with this adapter.

A function called 'Large Send' or sometimes known as TCP Segmentation is also provided by this adapter. This function offloads the TCP segmentation operation from the AIX IP layer to the adapter for outgoing (transmit side) TCP segments. Another function known as "Checksum Offload" which offloads the TCP/UDP Checksum Operation or workload from the CPU to the adapter is also provided.

The IBM 2-Port Gigabit Ethernet-SX PCI-X Adapter (#5707) should be considered where maximum port density is required per I/O card slot. For a suggested maximum number of adapters taking performance into consideration, refer to the RS/6000 & pSeries PCI Adapter Placement Reference SA38-0538. If card slots are not the limiting factor and maximum throughput is required, the single port IBM Gigabit Ethernet-SX PCI-X Adapter (#5700) is the preferred solution. Note: For optimum performance, the adapter should be placed in a 64 bit PCI-X card slot whenever possible.

Note: The 2-Port IBM Gigabit Ethernet-SX PCI-X Adapter incorporates an LC type connector on the card. This new, smaller form factor connector is being used by the industry for the next generation of fiber optic networks. If connecting into an older, existing SC type connector network, an LC-SC 62.5 Micron Fiber Converter Cable (#2459) or LC-SC 50 Micron Fiber Converter Cable (#2456) is required.

Limitation: Half Duplex (HDX) mode is not supported.

  • Attributes provided: Two full-duplex 1000Base-SX fiber connections to a Gigabit Ethernet LAN(s).
  • Attributes required: One available PCI or PCI-X card slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5707)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 5 (Initial order maximum: 5)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5709) Dual Channel SCSI RAID Enablement Card

(No Longer Available as of March 31, 2006)

The Dual Channel SCSI RAID Enablement Card (#5709) is a bootable high performance SCSI RAID Enablement feature providing RAID 0,5, or 10 capability to select pSeries systems with the appropriate supporting integrated SCSI adapter and internal multiple disk drives or packs of drives.

To increase the data writing performance, a 16 MByte non-volitile fast-write cache is provided as a resident part of this feature. The 16 MByte fast-write cache can provide an improvement in data throughput and response time during certain sequence write operations compared to SCSI RAID adapters without the fast-write cache. The response time and data transfer improvement will vary depending upon the data block sizes, the percentage of sequential writes, machine type/model, and application parameters.

When an array configuration is selected with the RAID Manager, the disk drives being designated as part of the array are required to be formatted to 522 byte sectors. 522 byte sectors provide additional CRC error checking for improved data integrity. A menu option is provided in the AIX supporting software which will reformat these disk drives prior to their usage in an array. Conversely, when a disk drive is removed from an array, a similar menu option is also provided to re-format them back to 512 byte sectors. Note: Some disk drives require that their microcode be updated to the latest level before being formatted to 522 Byte Sectors. Also, there are some disk drives which do not support being formatted to 522 Byte Sectors. The PCI-X SCSI Disk Array Manager will inform the user of these known situations when they exist. For disk microcode updates, go to the following web page URL:

http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/mdownload/

Limitations:

  • Even though the supporting integrated adapter with the Dual Channel SCSI RAID Enablement Card has ports that run at ultra320 SCSI speeds (up to 320 MBytes/s), the internally attached disk drives will run at a maximum SCSI bus data rate specified by that supporting system disk backplane.
  • Disk drives internal to the pSeries system shipped prior to September 1, 2003 require a disk drive microcode update to run at Ultra320 speed. To obtain the appropriate microcode update, go to the following web page URL:
    http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/mdownload/
  • Attributes provided: Internal disk drives to be configured as an array.
  • Attributes required: Systems with supporting integrated SCSI adapter.
  • For 9113-550: (#5709)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5712) PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter

(No Longer Available as of March 31, 2006)

The PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter (#5712) is a 64-bit 3.3 volt adapter and is an excellent solution for high-performance SCSI applications. The PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter provides two SCSI channels (busses), each capable of running 320 MBps (max.), up to twice the maximum data transfer rate of the previous Dual Channel Ultra3 SCSI adapter (160 MBps). Each SCSI bus can either be internal (on systems that support internal SCSI device or backplane attachments) or external. Internally attached Ultra320 devices are designed to run at a data rate of up to 320 MB per second on systems that have internal backplanes that are capable of supporting Ultra320 speeds.

In order to achieve an Ultra320 SCSI bus data rate of up to 320 MB per second and also maintain a reasonable drive distance, the adapter utilizes Low Voltage Differential (LVD) drivers and receivers. To fully utilize this 320 MB per second performance, all attaching devices should also be Ultra320 LVD devices. But, if Ultra2, Ultra3, or Ultra320 devices coexist on the same bus, each device will operate at its rated speed. For lower speed single-ended (SE) devices, the SCSI bus will switch to single-ended (SE) performance and interface to all devices on that SCSI bus at the lower SE bus data rate of the device.

Two industry standard VHDCI 68-pin connectors are mounted on the adapter's end bracket allowing attachment of various LVD and SE external subsystems. A .3 meter converter cable, VHDCI to P, Mini-68 pin to 68-pin, (#2118) can be used with older external SE devices or subsystems to allow connection to the VHDCI connector on the PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter.

The two external ports provide connectivity to an IBM 2104-DS4 Expandable Storage Plus Drawer or 2104-TS4 Expandable Storage Plus Tower at up to 320 MB/s SCSI bus data rate. The two external ports also provide connectivity to an IBM 2104-DU3 Expandable Storage Plus Drawer or 2104-TU3 Expandable Storage Plus Tower at up to 160 MB/s SCSI bus data rate and to an IBM 2104-DL1 Expandable Storage Plus Drawer or 2104-TL1 Expandable Storage Plus Tower at up to 80 MB/s SCSI bus data rate. Also the two external ports provide connectivity to numerous other SCSI external subsystems. Check the external subsystem sales/web pages for verification of connectivity support with this adapter.

The PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter (#5712) is a native boot adapter with AIX 5.1 or AIX 5.2 software in a supported pSeries or RS/6000 systems. The adapter also supports target mode.

Limitations:

  • The two external ports do not support the connection to the IBM 7131-105 IBM Multi-Storage Tower model 105.
  • Even though the Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter has ports that run at ultra320 SCSI speeds (up to 320 MBytes/s), the internally attached disk drives will run at a maximum SCSI bus data rate specified by that supporting system disk backplane.
  • Disk drives internal to the pSeries system shipped prior to September 1, 2003 require a disk drive microcode update to run at Ultra320 speed. To obtain the appropriate microcode update, go to the following web page URL:
    http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/mdownload/
  • Attributes provided: Attachment of internal SCSI devices (on systems that support an internal SCSI device or backplane attachment with this adapter) and external SCSI devices
  • Attributes required: One available 3.3 volt PCI or PCI-X slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5712)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 5 (Initial order maximum: 5)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5713) 1 Gigabit iSCSI TOE PCI-X on Copper Media Adapter

The 1 Gigabit iSCSI TOE PCI-X adapter encapsulates SCSI Commands and data into TCP and transports them over the Ethernet via IP packets. The adapter operates as an iSCSI TOE (TCP/IP Offload Engine). This offload function eliminates host protocol processing and reduces CPU interrupts. Adapter uses RJ45 Gigabit Ethernet connector.

  • Attributes provided: Offload of host protocol processing
  • Attributes required: Available PCI-X Slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5713)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 3 (Initial order maximum: 3 )
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: Max 27 per system.

(#5714) 1 Gigabit iSCSI TOE PCI-X on Optical Media Adapter

(No longer available as of August 29, 2008)

The 1 Gigabit iSCSI TOE PCI-X adapter encapsulates SCSI Commands and data into TCP and transports them over the Ethernet via IP packets. The adapter operates as an iSCSI TOE (TCP/IP Offload Engine). This offload function eliminates host protocol processing and reduces CPU interrupts. Adapter uses Small form factor LC type fiber optic connector.

  • Attributes provided: Offload of host protocol processing
  • Attributes required: Available PCI-X Slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5714)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 3 (Initial order maximum: 3 )
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: Max 27 per system

(#5716) 2 Gigabit Fibre Channel PCI-X Adapter

(No Longer Available as of July 27, 2007)

The 2 Gigabit Fibre Channel PCI-X Adapter is a 64-bit address/data, short form factor PCI-X adapter with an LC type external fiber connector that provides single or dual initiator capability over an optical fiber link or loop. With the use of appropriate optical fiber cabling, this adapter provides the capability for a network of high speed local and remote located storage. The 2 Gigabit Fibre Channel PCI-X Adapter will auto-negotiate for the highest data rate (either 1 Gbps or 2 Gbps) of which the device or switch is capable. Distances of up to 500 meters running at 1 Gbps data rate and up to 300 meters running at 2 Gbps data rate are supported between the adapter and an attaching device or switch. When used with IBM supported Fibre Channel storage switches supporting long-wave optics, distances of up to 10 kilometers are capable running at either 1 Gps or 2 Gps data rates.

The 2 Gigabit Fibre Channel PCI-X Adapter can be used to attach devices either directly, or by means of Fibre Channel Switches. If attaching a device or switch with a SC type fiber connector(s), use of an LC-SC 50 Micron Fiber Converter Cable (#2456) or a LC-SC 62.5 Micron Fiber Converter Cable (#2459) is required.

Refer to the following IBM storage subsystem Web page for additional supported server attachment information for IBM devices.

http://www.storage.ibm.com/hardsoft/disk/products.htm

Consult with your IBM representative or Business Partner for additional information relative to any third party attachment.

  • Attributes provided: 1 Fibre Channel/FC-AL interface
  • Attributes required: 1 empty PCI or PCI-X slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5716)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 5 (Initial order maximum: 5)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5718) 10 Gigabit Ethernet PCI-X Adapter

(No Longer Available as of May 31, 2006)

Provides 10 Gigabit Ethernet PCI-X based server connections. Supports distances of up to 33m using 62.5 um multimode fiber or 300m using 50 um multimode fiber with 2000MHz km minimum model bandwidth at 850 nm. Adapter connector type is LC.

  • Attributes provided: Provides highend bandwidth for networking
  • Attributes required: AIX V5.2.H and higher (No AIX V4 Support)
  • Attributes required: Supported on PCI-X slots only
  • For 9113-550: (#5718)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5719) IBM 10 Gigabit Ethernet-LR PCI-X Adapter

(No Longer Available as of May 31, 2006)

Offers 10 Gigabit Ethernet PCI-X based server connections over a maximum of 10 kilometers of 1310nm single-mode fiber optic cable. The adapter conforms to the IEEE 802.3ae standard. The adapter requires 9um single-mode fiber optic cables and uses a SC connector type for connecting into net-work infrastructure components like 10 Gigabit Ethernet switch/router with SC connectors.

  • Attributes provided: 10 Gigabit Ethernet connections
  • Attributes required: Available PCI-X slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5719)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: o AIX V5.2 or higher o Linux-Refer to the following Web site for Linux information:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eservers/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5721) - 10 Gb Ethernet-SR PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter

(No Longer Available as of November 27, 2009)

The adapter supports distances of up to 33m using 62.5 um multimode fiber or 300m using 50 um multimode fiber with 2000 MHz*km minimum model bandwidth at 850 nm wavelength. The fiber cable connects to the adapter with LC type connector. The adapter conforms to the IEEE 802.3ae standard.

  • Attributes provided: Provides high-end bandwidth for networking
  • Attributes required: PCI-X slot or for improved bandwidth plug into PCI-X 2.0 DDR slot.
  • For 9113-550: (#5721)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4 )
    • OS level required: AIX 5L Version 5.2 with the 5200-08 Technology Level (APAR IY77270) plus APAR IY83444 and IY84022, or later Technology Level. AIX 5L Version 5.3 with the 5300-04 Technology Level (APAR IY77273) plus APAR IY83424 and IY84026, or later Technology Level. SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later. Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS 4 for POWER, or later. Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
              http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
              hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: The minimum system firmware level required is SF240_205. Single Data Rate (SDR) mode is supported.

    System firmware can be downloaded from:

    http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/mdownload2/download.html

    Note: The combined cumulative total for feature 5718, 5719, 5721, and 5722 is 4.

(#5722) - 10 Gb Ethernet-LR PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter

(No Longer Available as of November 28, 2008)

The adapter supports a maximum of 10 kilometers of 1310nm 9um single- mode fiber optic cable. The adapter conforms to the IEEE 802.3ae standard. The adapter requires 9um single-mode fiber optic cables and uses a SC connector to facilitate connecting into network infrastructure components like 10 Gigabit Ethernet switch/router with SC connectors.

  • Attributes provided: 10 Gigabit Ethernet connections
  • Attributes required: PCI-X slot or for improved bandwidth plug in PCI-X 2.0 DDR slot.
  • For 9113-550: (#5722)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4 )
    • OS level required: AIX 5L Version 5.2 with the 5200-08 Technology Level (APAR IY77270) plus APAR IY83444 and IY84022, or later Technology Level. AIX 5L Version 5.3 with the 5300-04 Technology Level (APAR IY77273) plus APAR IY83424 and IY84026, or later Technology Level. SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later. Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS 4 for POWER, or later. Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
              http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
              hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: The minimum system firmware level required is SF240_205. Single Data Rate (SDR) mode is supported.

    System firmware can be downloaded from:

    http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/mdownload2/download.html

    Note: The combined cumulative total for feature 5718, 5719, 5721, and 5722 is 4.

(#5723) 2-Port Asynchronous EIA-232 PCI Adapter

(No Longer Available as of November 27, 2009)

Connection for 2 Asynchronous EIA-232 devices. Ports are Programmable to support EIA-232 protocols, at a line speed of 128K bps.

  • Attributes provided: 2 Asynchronous Ports
  • Attributes required: One PCI Slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5723)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: o AIX V5.2 or higher o Linux-Refer to the following Web site for Linux information:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eservers/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5727) - Dual Channel SCSI RAID Enablement Card

(No Longer Available as of December 12, 2008)

The Dual Channel SCSI RAID Enablement Card (#5727) is a bootable high performance SCSI RAID Enablement feature providing RAID 0,5, or 10 capability to select pSeries systems with the appropriate supporting integrated SCSI adapter and internal multiple disk drives or packs of drives. To increase the data writing performance, a 40 MByte nonvolatile fast-write cache is provided as a resident part of this feature. The 40 MByte fast-write cache can provide an improvement in data throughput and response time during certain sequence write operations compared to SCSI RAID adapters without the fast-write cache. The response time and data transfer improvement will vary depending upon the data block sizes, the percentage of sequential writes, machine type/model, and application parameters. When an array configuration is selected with the RAID Manager, the disk drives being designated as part of the array are required to be formatted to 522 byte sectors. A menu option is provided in the AIX supporting software which will reformat these disk drives prior to their usage in an array. Conversely, when a disk drive is removed from an array, a similar menu option is also provided to re- format them back to 512 byte sectors. Note: Some disk drives require that their microcode be updated to the latest level before being formatted to 522 Byte Sectors. Also, there are some disk drives which do not support being formatted to 522 Byte Sectors. The PCI-X SCSI Disk Array Manager will inform the user of these known situations when they exist. For disk microcode updates, go to the following Web page URL:

http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/mdownload/

Limitation: Even though the supporting integrated adapter with the Dual Channel SCSI RAID Enablement Card has ports that run at ultra320 SCSI speeds (up to 320 MBytes/s), the internally attached disk drives will run at a maximum SCSI bus data rate specified by that supporting system disk backplane.

  • Attributes provided: Internal disk drives can be configured as an array.
  • Attributes required: System with supporting integrated SCSI adapter and disk drives.
  • For 9113-550: (#5727)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later. Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS 4 for POWER, or later.
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5736) - PCI-X DDR Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter

(No Longer Available as of July 11, 2014)

The PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter (#5736) is a 64-bit 3.3 volt adapter and is an excellent solution for high-performance SCSI applications. The PCI-X DDR Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter provides two SCSI channels (busses), each capable of running 320 MBps (max.). Each SCSI bus can either be internal (on systems that support internal SCSI device or backplane attachments) or external. Internally attached Ultra320 devices are designed to run at a data rate of up to 320 MB per second on systems that have internal backplanes that are capable of supporting Ultra320 speeds.

In order to achieve an Ultra320 SCSI bus data rate of up to 320 MB per second and also maintain a reasonable drive distance, the adapter utilizes Low Voltage Differential (LVD) drivers and receivers. To fully utilize this 320 MB per second performance, all attaching devices should also be Ultra320 LVD devices. But, if Ultra2, Ultra3, or Ultra320 devices coexist on the same bus, each device will operate at its rated speed. For lower speed single-ended (SE) devices, the SCSI bus will switch to single-ended (SE) performance and interface to all devices on that SCSI bus at the lower SE bus data rate of the device.

Two VHDCI 68-pin connectors are mounted on the adapter's end bracket allowing attachment of various LVD and SE external subsystems. A .3 meter converter cable, VHDCI to P, Mini-68 pin to 68-pin, (#2118) can be used with older external SE devices or subsystems to allow connection to the VHDCI connector on the PCI-X DDR Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter.

The two external ports provide connectivity to numerous other SCSI external subsystems. Check the external subsystem sales/Web pages for verification of connectivity support with this adapter.

The PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter (#5736) is a native boot adapter with AIX 5L for POWER Version 5.2 with the 5200-07 Recommended Maintenance package (APAR IY67914) or AIX 5L for POWER Version 5.3 with the 5300-03 Recommended Maintenance package (APAR IY71011) or later software in a supported pSeries or RS/6000 systems. The adapter also supports target mode.

Limitations:

  • Even though the Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI nonRAID Adapter has ports that run at ultra320 SCSI speeds (up to 320 MBytes/s), the internally attached disk drives will run at a maximum SCSI bus data rate specified by that supporting system disk backplane.
  • To obtain microcode update go to the following Web page URL:
    http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/mdownload/
  • Attributes provided: Attachment of internal SCSI devices (on systems that support an internal SCSI device or backplane attachment with this adapter) and external SCSI devices
  • Attributes required: One available 3.3 volt PCI or PCI-X slot or PCI-X 2.0 DDR slot.
  • For 9113-550: (#5736)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 5 (Initial order maximum: 5)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later. Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS for POWER Version 4, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5737) PCI-X DDR Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter

(No Longer Available as of August 28, 2009)

The PCI-X DDR Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID LVD only Adapter (#5737) is a 64-bit 3.3 volt, bootable high performance Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter providing RAID 0, 5, 6, or 10 capability, and can address up to thirty 16-bit SCSI physical disk drives on two independent SCSI buses.

To increase the data writing performance, a 90 MByte non-volatile fast-write cache is a resident part of this adapter. The 90 MByte fast-write cache can provide a significant improvement in data throughput and response time during certain sequence write operations compared to SCSI RAID adapters without the fast-write cache. The response time and data transfer improvement will vary depending upon the data block sizes, the percentage of sequential writes, machine type/model, and application parameters.

The Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter has two independent ultra320 SCSI buses. There are two internal ports and two external ports. The two internal ports are shared with the two external ports. The SCSI busses can drive either an internal port or an external port. The internal ports can be used to provide an internal RAID solution on certain supporting pSeries systems with internal multiple disk drives or packs of drives. Internally attached Ultra320 devices designed to run at 320 MB can run up to 320 MB per second on systems that have internal backplanes that are capable of supporting Ultra320 speeds.

In order to achieve an Ultra320 SCSI bus data rate of up to 320 MB per second and maintain a reasonable drive distance, the adapter utilizes Low Voltage Differential (LVD) drivers and receivers. All attaching devices should be Ultra320 LVD devices to utilize the 320 MB per second performance, however, if Ultra2, Ultra3, or Ultra320 devices coexist on the same bus, each device will operate at its rated speed. This card does not support single-ended (SE) devices.

When an array configuration is selected with the RAID Manager, the disk drives being designated as part of the array (attached to either the internal or the external ports) are required to be formatted to 522-byte sectors. 522-byte sectors provide additional CRC error checking for improved data integrity. A menu option provide in the AIX supporting software, which will reformat these disk drives prior to their usage in an array. Conversely, when a disk drive is removed from an array, a similar menu option is also provided to re-format them back to 512-byte sectors.

Note: Some disk drives require that their microcode be updated to the latest level before being formatted to 522 Byte Sectors. In addition, there are some disk drives, which do not support 522 Byte Sectors format. The PCI-X SCSI Disk Array Manager will inform the user of these known situations when they exist. For disk microcode updates, go to the following web page URL:

http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/mdownload/

Two VHDCI 68-pin connectors are mounted on the adapter's end bracket allowing attachment of various LVD external subsystems.

Limitations:

  • Even though the Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter has ports that run at ultra320 SCSI speeds (up to 320 MBytes/s), the internally attached disk drives will run at a maximum SCSI bus data rate specified by that supporting system disk backplane.

Minimum System Firmware Required:

System firmware level required is SF235_185 or greater. Firmware level SF235_185 adjusts the PCI slots to run in Single Data Rate (SDR) mode. Enablement of Double Data Rate (DDR)slots to run at DDR mode is planned to be provided in an upcoming firmware enhancement.

For Double Data Rate (DDR), check for firmware upgrade at URL

http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/mdownload2/download.html

Running the adapter on a system with firmware level lower than SF235_185 is not supported.

  • Attributes provided: Attachment of internal and external SCSI devices
  • Attributes required: One PCI or PCI-X DDR bus slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5737)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 5 (Initial order maximum: 5 )
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later. Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS 4 for POWER, or later. Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5740) 4-Port 10/100/1000 Base-TX PCI-X Adapter

(No Longer Available as of November 27, 2009)

The 4-Port 10/100/1000 Base -TX PCI-X adapter is a full height PCI-X 1.0a Ethernet adapter which supports four Gigabit ports on a single adapter, delivers increased bandwidth for slot-constrained servers, and is designed to provide high connectivity and reliability using two integrated, dual-port Gigabit Ethernet controllers.

  • Four RJ-45 ports
  • 3.3 volts, 64-bit 133 MHz with 64-bit Bus Mastering on the PCI-X bus
  • IEEE 802.3ab 1000Base-T compliant
  • IEEE 802.3u 100Base-T compliant
  • IEEE 802.3 10Base-T compliant
  • 802.1q VLAN tagging
  • Interrupt Moderation
  • TCP Segmentation offload and encapsulation in hardware
  • Checksum offloading of IP, TCP, and UDP frame
  • Increased connectivity while significantly reducing CPU utilization
  • Two LED adapter status indicators per port for link activity and speed
  • NIM is supported on all 4 ports
  • RoHS compliant

Limit Full bandwidth performance may not be achieved with more than one adapter per PCI Host Bridge (PHB) or more than one CPU.

  • Attributes provided: Four 10/100/1000 RJ-45 ports
  • Attributes required: One available PCI-X card slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5740)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4 )
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later. Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS 4 for POWER, or later. Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5751) IBM 4.7 GB IDE Slimline DVD-RAM Drive

(No Longer Available as of May 29, 2009)

The IBM 4.7 GB IDE Slimline DVD-RAM Drive is an internal tray loading, multifunction storage device capable of reading and writing 4.7GB DVD-RAM discs as well as reading a multitude of other optical media discs. This drive also reads Type II (removable from cartridge) DVD-RAM discs. It is a 12.7mm high Slimline form factor, multi-session capable, DVD-RAM drive which provides state of the art performance. System boot and install functions are supported with CD-ROM and DVD-RAM media.

Characteristics:

  • Media Data Transfer Rate: 3600KB/sec CD-ROM (24X) max @ outer diameter; 10.8MB/sec read (8X DVD-ROM); 2.7MB/sec write (2X DVD-RAM) and 2.7MB/sec read (2X DVD-RAM)
  • Interface: Parallel IDE
  • Average Random Access Time: 150ms CD-ROM; 180ms DVD-ROM; 229ms DVD-RAM
  • Buffer Memory: 2MB
  • High-speed burst rate of 16/16/33 MB/second for PIO / MDMA / UDMA transfers respectively
  • Loading tray accommodates both 8cm discs and 12cm discs.
  • Operates in either vertical or horizontal position
  • Reads multi-session discs
  • Reads CD-ROM, CD-R, CD-RW, DVD-ROM, & DVD-RAM discs.
  • Reads 2.6GB DVD-RAM media; reads and writes 4.7GB and 9.4GB double sided) DVD-RAM media
  • Supports all major CD-ROM formats including Mode 1, Mode 2, XA, CDDA and audio

Limitations:

  • DVD video is not supported.
  • Drive only reads CD-type formatted media with AIX 5.1.
  • Attributes provided: One 4.7GB IDE Slimline DVD-RAM Drive
  • Attributes required: One IDE 12.7mm high media bay
  • For 9113-550: (#5751)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5755) - 200/400GB Half High Ultrium 2 Tape Drive

(No Longer Available as of November 27, 2009)

The IBM 200/400GB Half High Ultrium 2 Tape Drive is a 5.25-inch, half-high, Low Voltage Differential(LVD) 16-bit tape drive, which provides a high capacity for save/restore and achieve functions. This tape drive uses IBM Ultrium 1 and Ultrium 2 data cartridges and is compression capable, providing a typical capacity of up to 400GB.

Characteristics:

  • Capacity: 200 GB native and typical 400 GB capacity with 2:1 compression.
  • Form Factor: 5.25-inch half high
  • Media: Half High Ultrium 2 Tape Drive supports Ultrium 1 and Ultrium 2 data cartridges.
  • Operation: Streaming
  • Data Transfer Rate: 24MBps native mode, 48MBps with 2:1 compression.
  • The IBM 200/400GB Half High Ultrium 2 Tape Drives can read and write original LTO Ultrium Data Cartridges at original Ultrium 1 capacities at up to 16 MB/sec native(32 MB/sec with 2:1 compression).
  • Interface: SCSI Ultra-160,LVD Ultra-80, and Single-ended SCSI.
  • Compatibility: Ultrium 1 (Read/Write), Ultrium 2 (Read/Write).
  • Attributes provided: Ultrium 1 and Ultrium 2 tape capability
  • Attributes required: One 1.6-inch (41mm) half-high media bay and one SCSI-2 internal LVD 16-bit address
  • For 9113-550: (#5755)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1 )
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later. Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS for POWER Version 4, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/hardware/factsfeatures.html
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

Note: We recommend that you do not install server in an office environment. Run tape backup during off-hours.

(#5758) - 4 Gb Single-Port Fibre Channel PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter

The 4 Gigabit Single-Port Fibre Channel PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter is a 64-bit address/data, short form factor PCI-X adapter with an LC type external fiber connector that provides single initiator capability over an optical fiber link or loop. With the use of appropriate optical fiber cabling, this adapter provides the capability for a network of high-speed local and remote located storage. The 4 Gigabit Single-Port Fibre Channel PCI-X Adapter will auto-negotiate for the highest data rate between adapter and an attaching device at 1 Gbps, 2 Gbps or 4 Gbps of which the device or switch is capable. Distances of up to 500 meters running at 1 Gbps data rate, up to 300 meters running at 2 Gbps data rate, and 4 Gbps data rate up to 150 meters are supported between the adapter and an attaching device or switch. When used with IBM Fibre Channel storage switches supporting long-wave optics, distances of up to 10 kilometers are capable running at either 1 Gbps, 2 Gbps, or 4 Gbps data rates.

The 4 Gigabit Single-Port Fibre Channel PCI-X Adapter can be used to attach devices either directly, or by means of Fibre Channel Switches. If attaching a device or switch with a SC type fiber connector(s), use of an LC-SC 50 Micron Fiber Converter Cable (#2456) or a LC-SC 62.5 Micron Fiber Converter Cable (#2459) is required.

There are two maximum quantities for High Bandwidth adapters, one for performance, and one for connectivity. Adapter performance may be limited by bandwidth constraints in a network. To maximize High Bandwidth adapter performance in the server the performance maximum quantity should not be exceeded. In applications where the end-to-end network cannot sustain high performance and or connectivity is more important than overall bandwidth performance the performance maximum quantity can be exceeded up to the connectivity maximum quantity.

  • Connectivity Maximum: (5)
  • Performance Maximum: (4)

Refer to the following IBM storage subsystem Web page for additional supported server attachment information for IBM devices.

http://www.ibm.com/servers/storage/product/products_pseries.html

Consult with your IBM representative or Business Partner for additional information relative to any third party attachment.

  • Attributes provided: 1 Fibre Channel
  • Attributes required: 1 empty PCI or PCI-X 1.0 / 2.0 slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5758)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 5 (Initial order maximum: 5 )
    • OS level required: AIX 5L Version 5.2 with the 5200-08 Technology Level (APAR IY77270) plus APAR IY83649 and IY83172, or later Technology Level. AIX 5L Version 5.3 with the 5300-04 Technology Level (APAR IY77273) plus APAR IY83730 and IY83163, or later Technology Level. SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later. Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS 4 for POWER, or later. Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
             http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
             hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: The minimum system firmware level required is SF235_185. Single Data Rate (SDR) mode is supported.

    System firmware can be downloaded from:

    http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/mdownload2/download.html

(#5759) - 4 Gb Dual-Port Fibre Channel PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter

(No Longer Available as of July 11, 2014)

The 4 Gigabit Dual-Port Fibre Channel PCI-X 2.0 DDR Adapter is a 64-bit address/data, short form factor PCI-X adapter with an LC type external fiber connector that provides single or dual initiator capability over an optical fiber link or loop. With the use of appropriate optical fiber cabling, this adapter provides the capability for a network of high-speed local and remote located storage. The adapter will auto-negotiate for the highest data rate between adapter and an attaching device at 1 Gbps, 2 Gbps, or 4 Gbps of which the device or switch is capable. Distances of up to 500 meters running at 1 Gbps data rate, up to 300 meters running at 2 Gbps data rate, and 4 Gbps data rate up to 150 meters are supported between the adapter and an attaching device or switch. When used with IBM Fibre Channel storage switches supporting long-wave optics, distances up to 10 kilometers are capable running at either 1 Gbps, 2 Gbps, or 4 Gbps data rates.

The adapter can be used to attach devices either directly, or by means of Fibre Channel Switches. If attaching a device or switch with a SC type fiber connector(s), use of an LC-SC 50 Micron Fiber Converter Cable (#2456) or a LC-SC 62.5 Micron Fiber Converter Cable (#2459) is required.

There are two maximum quantities for High Bandwidth adapters, one for performance, and one for connectivity. Adapter performance may be limited by bandwidth constraints in a network. To maximize High Bandwidth adapter performance in the server the performance maximum quantity should not be exceeded. In applications where the end-to-end network cannot sustain high performance and or connectivity is more important than overall bandwidth performance the performance maximum quantity can be exceeded up to the connectivity maximum quantity.

  • Connectivity Maximum: (4)
  • Performance Maximum: (2)

Refer to the following IBM storage subsystem Web page for additional supported server attachment information for IBM devices.

http://www.ibm.com/servers/storage/product/products_pseries.html

Consult with your IBM representative or Business Partner for additional information relative to any third party attachment.

Note: Please carefully consider the usage of this card. If placed in a PCI-X slot rated as SDR compatible and/or has the slot speed of 133 MHz, the AIX value of the max_xfer_size must be kept at the default setting of 0x100000 (1 megabyte) when both ports are in use. The architecture of the DMA buffer for these slots does not accommodate larger max_xfer_size settings.

  • Attributes provided: 2 Fibre Channel
  • Attributes required: 1 empty PCI or PCI-X 2.0 slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5759)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4 )
    • OS level required: AIX 5L Version 5.2 with the 5200-08 Technology Level (APAR IY77270) plus APAR IY83649 and IY83172, or later Technology Level. AIX 5L Version 5.3 with the 5300-04 Technology Level (APAR IY77273) plus APAR IY83730 and IY83163, or later Technology Level. SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later. Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS 4 for POWER, or later. Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
             http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
             hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: The minimum system firmware level required is SF235_185. Single Data Rate (SDR) mode is supported.

    System firmware can be downloaded from:

    http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/mdownload2/download.html

(#5886) EXP 12S Expansion Drawer

(No Longer Available as of January 6, 2012)

The EXP 12S is an expansion drawer with twelve 3.5-inch form factor SAS bays. #5886 supports up to 12 hot-swap SAS Hard Disk Drives (HDD) or up to 8 hot-swap Solid State Drives (SSD). The EXP 12S includes redundant AC power supplies and two power cords. Though the drawer is one set of 12 drives which is run by one SAS controller or one pair of SAS controllers, it has two SAS attachment ports and two Service Managers for redundancy. The EXP 12S takes up a 2 EIA space in a 19-inch rack. The SAS controller can be a SAS PCI-X or PCIe adapter or pair of adapters or can be an imbedded SAS controller in a server with an imbedded SAS port such as the 8203 or 8204. Attachment to the controller is via the appropriate external SAS cables. A pair of #5886 EXP12S drawers can be attached together with SAS cables allowing the SAS controller(s) to access 24 SAS bays.

Note: SSD is not supported in #5886 when attach to Power 5 server.

  • Additional information can be found in the Technical Information section of the IBM System Storage EXP 12S Announce letter:
  • http://www-01.ibm.com/common/ssi/cgi-bin/ ssialias?infotype=AN&subtype=CA&htmlfid=897/ ENUS108-074&appname=USN#@2h@80@
  • Attributes provided: 12 SAS bays, slot filler panels are provided for empty bays when initially shipped from IBM.
  • Attributes required:
    • Available SAS controller (PCI or imbedded server controller)
    • Power System server, POWER5 or later
    • Available 2U 19-inch rack space
  • For 9113-550: (#5886)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 24 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required:
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-07 Technology Level and Service Pack 9, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-08 Technology Level and Service Pack 7, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-09 Technology Level and Service Pack 4, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-10 Technology Level, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-00 Technology Level and Service Pack 9, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-01 Technology Level and Service Pack 5, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-02 Technology Level and Service Pack 4, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-03 Technology Level, or later.
      • IBM i - not supported
      • SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 10, Service Pack 2 or later
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux version 4.7 or later
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux version 5.2 or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5902) PCI-X DDR Dual - x4 3Gb SAS RAID Adapter

(No Longer Available as of November 26, 2010)

The PCI-X DDR Dual - x4 3Gb SAS RAID Adapter is a long form factor adapter and is an excellent solution for high-performance applications requiring two adapters. Two #5902 provides for mirrored write cache data and mirrored RAID parity footprints between the adapters for superior availability. With proper cabling, multiple wide ports are used to provide redundant paths to each dual port SAS disk. The adapter manages SAS path redundancy and path switching should a SAS failure occur. RAID levels 0, 5, 6, and 10 are supported. It is used with FC 5886 EXP 12S SAS disk expansion drawers. FC 5902 is always to be in used in a High Availability configuration using two adapters.

Highlights

  • Supports up to 48 SAS disks, when configured with four FC 5886 12S disk expansion drawers
  • SAS speed = 3Gbs
  • SAS Serial SCSI Protocol (SSP)and Serial Management Protocol (SMP)
  • RAID 0, 5, 6, and 10
  • 175MB of NV Fast Write Cache
  • Dual controller supports mirrored write cache data and mirrored RAID parity footprints
  • Concurrent Firmware Update
  • Attributes provided: Eight physical links via two mini SAS 4x connectors.
  • Attributes required: One PCI-X 2.0 DDR slot per #5902. Configuration always requires even pairs of #5902. SAS Media devices are not supported. When attaching #5886 EXP 12S use one of the following SAS (X) cables #3661, #3662 or #3663 must be used.
  • For 9113-550: (#5902)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required:
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-07 Technology Level and Service Pack 9, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-08 Technology Level and Service Pack 7, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-09 Technology Level and Service Pack 4, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-10 Technology Level, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-00 Technology Level and Service Pack 9, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-01 Technology Level and Service Pack 5, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-02 Technology Level and Service Pack 4, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-03 Technology Level, or later.
      • IBM i - not supported
      • SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 10, Service Pack 2 or later
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux version 4.7 or later
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux version 5.2 or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: The system Max is twenty-four with attached I/O drawers.

(#5912) PCI-X DDR Dual - x4 SAS Adapter

(No Longer Available as of July 11, 2014)

The PCI-X DDR Dual Connector x4 SAS Adapter is a low-profile short form factor adapter and is an excellent solution for high-performance applications. With proper cabling, multiple wide ports are used to provide redundant paths to each dual port SAS disk. The adapter manages SAS path redundancy and path switching should a SAS failure occur. RAID levels 0 and 10 are supported. FC 5912 may also be used in a High Availability configuration using two adapters.

Highlights

  • Supports up to 48 SAS disks, when configured with four FC 5886 12S disk expansion drawers
  • Removable Media Device Supported
  • SAS speed = 3Gbs
  • SATA speed = 1.5Gbs
  • SAS Serial SCSI Protocol (SSP) , Serial ATA Tunneling Protocol (STP) and Serial Management Protocol (SMP)
  • RAID 0 and 10
  • Dual controller supports mirrored RAID parity footprints
  • Concurrent Firmware Update
  • Attributes provided: Eight physical links via two mini SAS 4x connectors
  • Attributes required: One PCI-X 2.0 DDR slot
  • For 9113-550: (#5912)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 5 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required:
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-07 Technology Level and Service Pack 9, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-08 Technology Level and Service Pack 7, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-09 Technology Level and Service Pack 4, or later.
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-10 Technology Level, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-00 Technology Level and Service Pack 9, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-01 Technology Level and Service Pack 5, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-02 Technology Level and Service Pack 4, or later.
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-03 Technology Level, or later.
      • IBM i - not supported
      • SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 10, Service Pack 2 or later
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux version 4.7 or later
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux version 5.2 or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: The system Max is twelve with attached I/O drawers.

(#5922) Non-paired SAS RAID indicator

Feature 5922 must be added for every instance of a non-paired SAS RAID adapter #5902. It identifies a specific high availability configuration supported by AIX or Linux which has one #5902 on one system and the paired #5902 located on a second system.

  • Attributes provided: SAS RAID adapter firmware disables write cache until a second SAS RAID adapter is recognized.
  • Attributes required: Every #5922 requires a SAS RAID adapter on both this server and on another server that will pair up the SAS RAID adapter and enable the onboard caches to function.
  • For 9113-550: (#5922)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 24 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: none
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5951) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, US English, #103P

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached US English #103P keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5951)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5952) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, French, #189

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached French #189 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5952)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5953) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Italian, #142

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Italian #142 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5953)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5954) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, German/Austrian, #129

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached German/Austrian #129 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5954)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5955) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, UK English, #166P

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached UK English #166 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5955)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5956) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Spanish, #172

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Spanish #172 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5956)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5957) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Japanese, #194

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Japanese #194P keyboard. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5957)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5958) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Brazilian Portuguese, #275

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Brazilian Portuguese #275 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5958)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5959) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Hungarian, #208

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Hungarian #208 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5959)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5960) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Korean, #413

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Korean #413 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5960)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5961) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Chinese, #467

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Chinese #467 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5961)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5962) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, French Canadian, #445

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached French Canadian #445 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5962)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5963) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Canadian French, #058

(No longer available as of August 29, 2008)

This feature provides a USB attached Canadian French #058 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5963)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5964) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Belgian/French, #120

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Belgian/French #120 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5964)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5965) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Swedish/Finnish, #153

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Swedish/Finnish #153 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5965)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5966) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Danish, #159

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Danish #159 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5966)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5967) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Bulgarian, #442

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Bulgarian #442 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5967)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5968) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Swiss/French/German, #150

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Swiss, French/German #150 /F/G keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5968)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5969) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Norwegian,#155

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Norwegian #155 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5969)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5970) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Dutch, #143

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Dutch #143 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5970)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5971) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Portuguese, #163

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Portuguese #163 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5971)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5972) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Greek, #319

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Greek #319 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5972)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5973) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Hebrew, #212

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Hebrew #212 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5973)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5974) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Polish, #214

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Polish #214 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5974)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5975) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Slovakian, #245

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Slovakian #245 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5975)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5976) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Czech, #243

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Czech #243 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5976)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5977) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Turkish, #179

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Turkish #179 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5977)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5978) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, LA Spanish, #171

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached LA Spanish #171 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5978)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5979) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Arabic, #253

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Arabic #253 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5979)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5980) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Thai, #191

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Thai #191 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5980)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5981) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Russian, #443

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Russian #443 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5981)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5982) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, Slovenian, #234

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached Slovenian #234 keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion. Color is Business Black.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5982)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#5983) Full Width Quiet Touch Keyboard -- USB, US English International, #103P

(No Longer Available as of August 31, 2012)

This feature provides a USB attached US English International #103P keyboard with a 3m cable. The two built-in USB ports conveniently provide for additional expansion.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#5983)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6001) Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 2 meter

(No Longer Available as of September 14, 2007)

This feature provides a two-meter power control cable.

  • Attributes provided: 2M power control cable
  • Attributes required: I/O drawer
  • For 9113-550: (#6001)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6006) Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 3 meter

This feature provides a three-meter power control cable.

  • Attributes provided: 3M power control cable.
  • Attributes required: two drawers in the same rack.
  • For 9113-550: (#6006)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6007) Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 15 meter

This feature provides a fifteen-meter power control cable.

  • Attributes provided: 15M power control cable.
  • Attributes required: I/O drawer
  • For 9113-550: (#6007)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6008) Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 6 meter

(No Longer Available as of January 4, 2010)

This feature provides a six-meter power control cable.

  • Attributes provided: 6M power control cable
  • Attributes required: I/O drawer
  • For 9113-550: (#6008)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6029) Power Control Cable (SPCN) - 30 meter

(No longer available as of August 29, 2008)

This feature provides a thirty-meter power control cable.

  • Attributes provided: 30M power control cable.
  • Attributes required: two drawers in the same rack.
  • For 9113-550: (#6029)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6120) IBM 80/160 GB Internal Tape Drive with VXA Technology

(No longer available as of February 29, 2008)

The IBM 80/160 GB Internal Tape Drive with VXA** Technology is a 5.25-inch, half-high, Ultra2 LVD 16-bit tape drive, which provides a high capacity for save/restore and achieve functions. This tape drive uses VXAtape** data cartridges and is compression capable, providing a capacity of up to 160 GB - a significant increase in capacity over the previous internal tape drives.

Characteristics

  • Capacity: 80 GB native mode, 160 GB (typical) compression mode
  • Form Factor: 5.25-inch half high
  • Media: uses VXAtape data cartridges
  • Technology: Helical scan, rotating head
  • Operation: Streaming
  • Data Transfer Rate: 6MBps native mode, 12MBps (typical) compression
  • Interface: SCSI-2 (LVD/SE) asynchronous/synchronous
  • Compatability: 80 GB mode (Read/Write), 160 GB compression (Read/Write)
  • Attributes provided: One 80/160 GB internal tape drive
  • Attributes required: One 1.6-inch (41mm) half-high media bay and one SCSI-2 internal 16-bit address
  • For 9113-550: (#6120)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6134) 60/150 GB 16-bit 8mm Internal Tape Drive

(No Longer Available as of June 24, 2005)

The 60/150GB 16-bit 8mm Internal Tape Drive consists of a 5.25-inch half-high, 16-bit tape drive. This drive provides a high capacity tape drive for save/restore and archiving functions. This tape drive uses IBM 8mm data cartridges and is compression capable, providing a capacity of up to 150 GB -- up to 375% increase over the previous 20/40GB 8mm internal tape drive. The 60/150 GB 16-bit 8mm Internal Tape Drive, is limited to a maximum system ambient operating temperature of 31C (87.8F) at a maximum operating altitude of 2134m (7000 ft). Lower altitudes have higher maximum ambient operating temperatures. Refer to the "IBM Site and Hardware Planning Information Guide" (SA38-0508) for additional details.

Characteristics:

  • Capacity: 60 GB Native Mode, 150 GB (typical) Compression Mode
  • Form Factor: 5.25-inch Half-high
  • Media: IBM 8mm Data Cartridge with Smart Clean Technology
  • Technology: Helical Scan, Rotating Head
  • Operation: Streaming
  • Data Transfer Rate: 12 MB/Sec. Native Mode, 30 MB/Sec. (typical) Compression M
  • Interface: SCSI-2 16-bit Low Voltage Differential(LVD) / Single-ended (SE) Asynchronous/Synchronous
  • Compatibility: See the following Technical Support Web page (8mm Tape Interchange Information section) for compatibility information -
    http://techsupport.services.ibm.com/server/ mdownload/tapewhdr.html
  • Attributes provided: 60/150GB 16-bit 8mm Internal Tape Drive
  • Attributes required: One 1.6-inch(41mm) half-high media bay and one SCSI-2 internal 16-bit address
  • For 9113-550: (#6134)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6204) PCI Universal Differential Ultra SCSI Adapter

(No Longer Available as of December 30, 2005)

The PCI Universal Differential Ultra SCSI Adapter is the latest technology advancement of an RS/6000 SCSI-2 differential adapter with a maximum data transfer rates of 40 MBytes per second. This adapter has the capability to be plugged into the newer +3.3 volt PCI slots as well as the older +5 volt PCI slots. Feature code # 6204 allows connection to external differential SCSI-2 F/W or Ultra SCSI type devices up to 25 meters away. Feature code # 6204 will negotiate with each external device and transfer data at the fastest SCSI data transfer rate capable by the external device. Check system sales pages as to which external differential subsystems are supported.

The adapter conforms to SCSI-2 standard and the Fast-20 (Ultra) documentation. Industry standard 68 pin connectors are incorporated (SCSI "P" connector definition of X3T9.2/90-048).

  • Attributes provided: 15 external SCSI-2 addresses
  • Attributes required: 1 PCI slot.
  • For 9113-550: (#6204)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6230) Advanced SerialRAID Plus Adapter

The Advanced SerialRAID Plus Adapter (#6230) is a 4 port (2 loop) Serial Storage Architecture (SSA) adapter providing an instantaneous data transfer rate of up to 160 MByte/s per loop. It also provides eight-initiator, non-RAID capability, two-initiator RAID 1, two-initiator RAID 0 + 1, two-initiator RAID 5, or one-initiator RAID 0 capability. The adapter accepts a 32 MByte Fast-Write Cache Option Card (#6235) that improves write performance in RAID 0+1, RAID 5, and non-RAID applications. When the 32 MByte Fast-Write Cache Option Card is used, the adapter can be configured in either single or dual initiator fast-write cache mode. In dual initiator fast-write cache mode, if one of the two adapters fail, the failing adapter is designed to transfer control over to the other. Also, in dual initiator Fast Write Cache mode, the 128 MByte DRAM Option Card (#6231) is available and required to utilize the full 32 MBytes of fast-write cache on the adapters. If the 128 MByte DRAM Option Card is not used in dual initiator fast-write cache mode, the effective fast-write cache capacity will be 16 MBytes on each adapter. See the 128 MByte DRAM Option Card (#6231) for information.

The Advanced SerialRAID Plus Adapter when operated in a RAID 5 configuration will support (2+P) to (15+P) arrays and up to 6 (15+P) arrays. When operated in a RAID 1 or RAID 0+1 configuration, will support up to eight disk drives mirrored. The adapter also supports Hot Spares in RAID 5 and RAID 0+1 mode. The Advanced SerialRAID Plus Adapter also supports connectivity to external disk enclosures and internal RS/6000 SSA configurations. Optional SSA Fiber-Optic Extender is also supported (Refer to IBM 7133 Sales literature for additional information)

Any supported RS/6000 system can be set up to boot from an Advanced SerialRAID Plus Adapter (#6230), provided a non-RAID SSA disk is included as part of the configuration. Other disks associated with the adapter can be RAID but at least one disk must be a non-RAID SSA disk. The non-RAID SSA disk can be located under the covers of a processor unit or in an external SSA storage unit. If your system is running with AIX 4.3.3 or later software, native boot capability is supported. For factory system orders with AIX preload requested, an internal SCSI disk drive will be preloaded as the native boot disk even if internal SSA disk drive(s) are present. If your system is running with AIX 4.2.1 or AIX 4.3.2 software, the below procedure applies in order to boot using the Advanced SerialRAID Plus Adapter:

  • The non-RAID SSA disk can be located under the covers of a processor unit or in an external SSA storage unit.
  • A supported AIX version of software (with proper updates) must be loaded to the non-RAID SSA disk using AIX's Network Install Manager (NIM) before booting from the non-RAID disk.
  • The system with a non-RAID SSA disk must have a network connection with another RS/6000 system performing the NIM Master function to perform the install. On RS/6000 SP systems, a similar network install is performed from a control workstation.
  • Once AIX with updates is installed on the non-RAID SSA disk and the system is configured for booting, booting will take place from the boot disk without any support from the control processor or NIM Master and the system does not have to be connected to the network at boot time.

After October 3, 2000, a 3-Way Copy Function will be available. This 3-Way Copy Function allows a user to create a third copy to an existing RAID-1 or RAID 0+1 array while mirrored operation continues. 3-Way Copy allows the user, at any time after the copy process has completed, to split the third copy off from the original RAID-1 or RAID 0+1 array to form an independent RAID copy. This third copy or "snapshot" copy could be typically used to perform a backup or to test some new application. The 3-Way Copy Function is available only via a code download and can only be gained by going to the SSA web support pages defined below.

When performing SSA device or subsystem planning, installation, upgrades, or preventive maintenance, refer to the following Web support pages. They provide access to the latest SSA publications and support code for the system, SSA adapters, and SSA subsystems. These sites should also be considered during system hardware and/or operating system upgrades if SSA devices are included in the system:

http://www.storage.ibm.com/hardsoft/products/ssa/

The above link contains links to SSA publications and other SSA Web sites, including the one below:

http://www.storage.ibm.com/hardsoft/products/ssa/rs6k/index.html

The above link contains lists of the latest SSA support code and provides code download capability for the RS/6000 and AIX environments.

LIMITATION: Internal ports on the adapter are not supported. See machine/model specific information to determine if internal SSA disk drives and associated hardware/cables are supported.

  • Attributes provided: Attachment of SSA devices
  • Attributes required: One PCI bus slot
  • For 9113-550: (#6230)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Supported
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#6231) 128 MByte DRAM Option Card

The 128 MByte DRAM Option Card (#6231) is a field only optional feature to the Advanced SerialRAID Adapter (#6225) or a factory or field option for the Advanced SerialRAID Plus Adapter (#6230). This option is recommended for dual initiator fail-over Fast Write Cache (FWC) configurations. The option increases the existing DRAM on the adapter to 128 MBytes. In this type of dual initiator FWC configuration, the existing DRAM does not have enough capacity to completely contain a copy of each adapter's 32 MByte FWC and also provide additional working space. The 128 MByte DRAM Option Card provides this additional space needed to contain a full copy of each adapters 32 MByte FWC content and allows for full 32 MByte fail-over protection. If the 128 MByte DRAM Option Card (#6231) is not used with dual-initiator FWC configurations, the effective FWC capacity is reduced to 16 MBytes per adapter.

If this feature is ordered as a field upgrade to an existing SerialRAID adapter (#6225 or 6230), a CD-ROM with appropriate software and publications are also provided.

  • Attributes provided: 128 MByte DRAM memory
  • Attributes required: Advanced SerialRAID Adapter (#6225) or Advanced SerialRAID Plus Adapter (#6230). A 32 MByte Fast-Write Cache Option Card (#6235) is also recommended.
  • For 9113-550: (#6231)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Supported
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#6235) 32 MByte Fast-Write Cache Option Card

The 32 MByte Fast-Write Cache Option Card (#6235) is a 32 MByte fast-write optional feature that plugs into the IBM RS/6000 Advanced SerialRAID Adapter (#6225) or the Advanced SerialRAID Adapter Plus (#6230). It utilizes non-volatile RAM. During the unlikely event of an Advanced SerialRAID Adapter failure, a replacement Advanced SerialRAID Adapter can be installed and the fast-write cache can be removed from the failing adapter and installed in the new adapter insuring data integrity. The 32 MByte Fast-Write Cache Option Card can provide a significant improvement of data throughput and response time during certain sequence write operations compared to SSA RAID adapters without the fast-write cache. The response time and data transfer improvement using the optional card will vary depending upon the data block sizes, the percentage of sequential writes, machine type/model, and application parameters. The 32 MByte Fast-Write Cache Option Card plugged into the Advanced SerialRAID Adapter (# 6225) will operate in either non-RAID or RAID 5 mode, in single-initiator configurations. The 32 MByte Fast-Write Cache Option Card plugged into the Advanced Serial RAID Plus Adapter (# 6230) will operate in non-RAID, RAID 5, or RAID 0+1 mode, in single-initiator or dual initiator configurations.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: One Advanced SerialRAID Adapter (#6225) or Advanced SerialRAID Plus Adapter (#6230).
  • For 9113-550: (#6235)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Supported
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#6258) 36/72GB 4mm Internal Tape Drive

(No Longer Available as of May 29, 2009)

The 36/72 GB 4-mm Internal Tape Drive is a 5.25-inch, half-high, single-ended 16-bit tape drive, which provides a high capacity for save/restore and archive functions. This tape drive uses IBM 4-mm data cartridges and is compression capable, providing a capacity of up to 72 GB - a significant increase in capacity over the previous 20/40 4-mm internal tape drives (when using DDS-4 media).

Characteristics:

  • Capacity: 36 GB native mode, 72 GB (typical) compression mode
  • Form Factor: 5.25-inch half high
  • Media: IBM 4-mm supports new DAT72 media
  • Technology: Helical scan, rotating head
  • Operation: Streaming
  • Data Transfer Rate: 3MBps native mode, 6MBps (typical) compression
  • Interface: SCSI-2 LVD and single ended

Compatability:

  • DDS3 - 12 GB native (Read/Write), 24 GB compression (Read/Write)
  • DDS4 - 20 GB native (Read/Write), 40 GB compression (Read/Write)
  • DAT72 - 36 GB native (Read/Write), 72 GB compression (Read/Write)
  • Attributes provided: 4mm tape capability
  • Attributes required: One 1.6-inch (41mm) half-high media bay and one SCSI-2 LVD internal 16-bit address or SE
  • For 9113-550: (#6258)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6271) - LTO Ultrium 200GB Data Cartridge

(No Longer Available as of May 31, 2006)

LTO Ultrium 200GB Data Cartridge highlights:

By combining high storage capacity (200 GB native, 400 GB with 2:1 compression), performance, and reliability, the IBM Total Storage LTO Ultrium 200 GB Data Cartridges continue the IBM focus on enhancing tape technology. The cartridge is part of a long line of IBM data cartridges that help provide quality and reliability for organizations around the world.

The IBM Total Storage LTO Ultrium 200 GB data cartridge, with a compressed capacity of up to 400 GB (2:1 compression), can be used in products featuring Ultrium 2 Tape Drives.

Characteristics:

  • Provides capacity, performance and reliability for midrange and network tape automated storage environments
  • Contains half-inch metal particle tape; cartridges feature a native data capacity of 200GB and a compressed data capacity of 400GB (2:1 compression)
  • Includes a Linear Tape-Open Cartridge Memory (LTO - CM) chip that contains cartridge specific information to communicate with Ultrium Tape Drives during loading/unloading via a radio frequency component
  • Attributes required: Storage conditions: 61-90F (16-32C);20-80% RH; 79F (26C) wet bulb max.
  • Cartridge disposal: Classified as nonhazardous waste per EPA regulation 40CFR261; can be disposed of as normal office trash.
  • Attributes provided: Ultrium 1 and Ultrium 2 compatible
  • Attributes required: LT02 Tape Drive and Tape operating conditions between 50-104 F, (10-40C); 20-80% RH; 79F (26C) wet Bulb max.
  • For 9113-550: (#6271)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 5 (Initial order maximum: 5 )
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6279) - VXA-320 160/320GB Internal Tape Drive

(No longer available as of August 29, 2008)

The IBM 160/320 GB Internal Tape Drive with VXA* Technology is a 5.25-inch, half-high, Ultra2 LVD 16-bit tape drive, which provides a high capacity for save/restore and archive functions. The tape drive uses "X" media VXAtape* data cartridges and is compression capable, providing a capacity of up to 320 GB - a significant increase in capacity, and data transfer rate over the previous internal tape drives.

Characteristics

  • Capacity: 160 GB native mode
  • Capacity: 320 GB compress mode, typical
  • Form Factor: 5.25-inch half high
  • Media: uses VXAtape "X" media data cartridges
  • Technology: Helical scan, rotating head
  • Operation: Streaming
  • Data Transfer Rate: 12 MBps native mode, 24MBps (typical) compression
  • Interface: SCSI-2,SCSI-3 Ultra 160 (LVD) asynchronous/synchronous
  • VXA-320 is read/write capable on X23, X10 and X6 media
  • Compatibility: VXA-2 format (Read/Write) on X6, X10, and X23, VXA-320 format (Read/Write) on X6, X10, and X23.
  • Attributes provided: One 160/320GB internal tape drive
  • Attributes required: One 1.6-inch (41mm) half-high media bay and one SCSI-2 internal 16-bit address
  • For 9113-550: (#6279)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 0 )
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later. Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS 4 for POWER, or later.
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Support
    • CSU: No
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#6310) - IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad Digital Trunk PCI Adapter

Provides voice processing for up to four T1 or E1 digital trunks, providing connectivity for 96 (T1) or 120 (E1) voice channels in a single PCI slot. The voice processing function is provided by Voice Response for AIX LPP. Several network attachment cables are available in support of this adapter and the correct cable should be selected for either T1 or E1 networks. (Select from cable features: 2709 (T1,RJ-45), 2710 (E1, RJ-45), 2871/2872 (T1, 100 ohm), 2873/2874 (E1, 120 ohm).

Note: When more than one IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad Digital Trunk PCI Adapter (#6310) is ordered, the Artic960RxD Quad DTA, H.100, 4-drop Cable (#2877) is required.

Note: When a Digital Trunk Quad PCI adapter (#6309) is already present and an IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad Digital Trunk PCI Adapter (#6310) is ordered, an IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, SC Bus, 5-drop Cable (#2878) and IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, Four-H.100 to SC Bus Converter Cable (#2879) are required.

Note: When an IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad Digital Trunk PCI Adapter (#6310) is ordered and an IBM ARTIC960RxD DSP Resource PCI Adapter (#2949) is already present, the IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, SC Bus, 5-drop Cable (#2878) and the IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad DTA, Four-H.100 to SC Bus Converter Cable (#2879) are required.

Note: This adapter may have AIX 5.1 support limitations. Go to the following URL to view the latest AIX 5.1 support limitation statements.

http://www.ibm.com/servers/aix/os/adapters/51.html

  • Attributes provided: Connection of 1 to 4 T1/E1 Trunk lines.
  • Attributes required: Available PCI slot, appropriate cables and WebSphere Voice Response for AIX LPP application software.
  • For 9113-550: (#6310)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later.
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Support
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#6312) Quad Digital Trunk Telephony PCI Adapter

(No Longer Available as of November 26, 2010)

The Quad Digital Trunk Telephony PCI Adapter is a highly integrated, intelligent IO adapter designed for use in computer telephony applications. The adapter is a 4 port, full length, universal PCI 2.2 compliant adapter. It performs voice processing for up to four T1 or E1 digital trunks, providing connectivity for 96 (T1) or 120 (E1) voice channels in a single PCI slot. The adapter is made up of two separate cards. A base card that interfaces with the host system and performs telephony processing functions, and an adapter that provides the physical interface to the switch. The voice processing function is provided by WebSphere Voice Response for AIX LPP with Direct Talk Technology.

In conjunction with this adapter, network attachment cables using industry standard RJ-48 connector can be obtained from commercial cable suppliers in a variety of lengths to suit the particular installation. Additional information about these cables can be obtained by referring to this adapter's Installation and User's Guide.

Note: When 2 to 4 Quad Digital Trunk Telephony PCI Adapters (#6312) are ordered and planned to be used in a single partition, the Artic960RxD Quad DTA, H.100, 4-drop Cable (#2877) is required. When more than 4 Quad Digital Trunk Telephony PCI Adapters (#6312) are ordered and planned to be used in a single partition, the H.100 Bus 8-Position Cable (#4353) is required.

Limitations: The Quad Digital Trunk Telephony PCI Adapter (#6312) cannot reside in the same system with the IBM ARTIC960RxD Quad Digital Trunk PCI Adapter (#6310). The Quad Digital Trunk Telephony PCI Adapter (#6312) is only supported in machines running in a full system partition.

  • Attributes provided: Connection of 1 to 4 T1/E1 Trunk lines.
  • Attributes required: One available PCI slot and WebSphere Voice Response for AIX LPP application software.
  • For 9113-550: (#6312)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: No
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6458) Power Cable -- Drawer to IBM PDU, 14-foot, 250V/10A

Standard IBM rack power cable that goes from the system or I/O drawer to the rack power distribution unit (PDU).

  • Attributes provided: Power cable
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6458)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6460) Power Cord (14-foot), Drawer to OEM PDU (125V, 15A), Plug Type #4

This power cord goes from the system or I/O drawer to the rack power distribution unit. Plug type #4 (NEMA 5-15). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. 14-foot length. The following countries/regions use the #6460 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord:

   United States, Antigua & Barbuda, Aruba, Bahamas, Barbados, Belize,
   Bermuda, Bolivia, Bonnaire, Calicos Islands, Canada, Cayman Islands,
   Colombia, Costa Rica, Cuba, Curacao, Dominican Republic, Ecuador,
   El Salvador, Guam, Guatemala, Guyana, Haiti, Honduras, Jamaica,
   Japan, Mexico, Micronesia, Montserrat, Netherlands Antilles,
   Nicaragua, Panama, Peru, Philippines, St. Kitts/Nevis, St. Martin,
   Taiwan, Tortola (BVI), Trinidad/Tobago, Venezuela.
 
  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6460)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6469) Power Cord (14-foot), Drawer to OEM PDU (250V, 15A), United States, Plug Type #5

This power cord goes from the system or I/O drawer to the rack power distribution unit. Plug type #5 (NEMA 6-15). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. 14-foot length. The following countries/regions use the #6469 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: United States, Anguilla, Antigua & Barbuda, Aruba, Bahamas, Barbados, Belize, Bermuda, Bolivia, Bonnaire, Caicos Is., Canada, Cayman Islands, Colombia, Costa Rica, Cuba, Curacao, Dominican Republic, Ecuador, El Salvador, Guam, Guatamala, Haiti, Honduras, Jamaica, Japan, Micronesia, Montserrat, Netherlands Antilles, Nicaragua, Panama, Peru, Philippines, St. Marten NA, Taiwan, Tortola (BVI), Thailand, Venezuela.

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6469)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6470) Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall (125V, 15A), Plug Type #4

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #4 (NEMA 5-15). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. 6-foot length. The following countries/regions use the #6470 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord:

   United States, Antigua & Barbuda, Aruba, Bahamas, Barbados, Belize,
   Bermuda, Bolivia, Bonnaire, Calicos Islands, Canada, Cayman Islands,
   Colombia, Costa Rica, Cuba, Curacao, Dominican Republic, Ecuador,
   El Salvador, Guam, Guatemala, Guyana, Haiti, Honduras, Jamaica,
   Japan, Mexico, Micronesia, Montserrat, Netherlands Antilles,
   Nicaragua, Panama, Peru, Philippines, St. Kitts/Nevis, St. Martin,
   Taiwan, Tortola (BVI), Trinidad/Tobago, Venezuela.
 
  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6470)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6471) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (125V, 15A), Plug Type #70

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #70 (iNMETRO NBR 6147, NEMA 5-15). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6471 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: Brazil

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6471)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6472) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 16A), Plug Type #18

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #18 (CEE 7 VII). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6472 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord:

   Afghanistan, Albania, Algeria, Andorra, Angola, Armenia, Austria,
   Belarus, Belgium, Benin, Bosnia/Herzegovina, Bulgaria, Burkina Faso,
   Burundi, Cambodia, Cameroon, Cape Verde, Central African Republic,
   Chad, Comoros, Conogo, Croatia, Czech Republic, Dahomey, Djibuouti,
   Egypt, Equatorial Guinea, Eritrea, Estonia, Etrhiopia, Finland,
   France, French Polynesia, French Guyana, Gabon, Georgia, Germany,
   Greece, Guadeloupe, Guinea, Guinea-Bissau, Hungary, Iceland,
   Indonesia, Iran, Ivory Coast, Kazakhstan, Krygystan, Laos, Latvia,
   Lebanon, Lintuania, Luxembourg, Macau, Macedonia, Mali, Martinigue,
   Mauritania, Mauritus, Mayotte, Moldova, Monaco, Mongolia, Morocco,
   Mozambique, Netherlands, New Caledonia, Niger, North Korea (C19
   only), Norway, Poland, Portugal, Principe, Reunion, Romania, Russia,
   Rwanda, St. Thomas, Saudi Arabia, Senegal, Serbia, Slovenia,
   Somalia, South Korea (C19 only), Spain, Surinam, Sweden, Syria,
   Tahiti, Tajikistan, Togo, Tunesia, Turkey, Turkmenistan, Ukraine,
   Upper Volta, Uzbekistan, Vanuatu, Vietnam, Wallis & Futuna, Zaire,
   Zimbabwe.
 
  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6472)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6473) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #19

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #19 (CEE). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6473 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: Denmark

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6473)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6474) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 13A), Plug Type #23

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #23 (BS 1364A). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6474 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord:

   Abu Dhabi, Bahrain, Botswana, Brunei, Channel Islands, Cyprus,
   Dominica, Gambia, Grenada, Grenadines, Guyana, Hong Kong, Iraq,
   Ireland, Jordan, Kenya, Kuwait, Liberia, Malawi, Malaysia, Malta,
   Myanmar, Nigeria, Oman, Qatar, Sierra Leone, Singapore, St. Kitts,
   St. Lucia, Seychelles, Sudan, Tanzania, Trinidad & Tobago, United
   Arab Emirates, United Kingdom, Yemen, Zambia
 
  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6474)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6475) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 16A), Plug Type #32

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #32 (SII 32-1971). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6475 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: Israel

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6475)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6476) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #24

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #24 (SEV 24507). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6476 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: Lichtenstein, Switzerland.

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6476)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6477) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 16A), Plug Type #22

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #22 (SABS 164). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6477 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord:

  • Bangladesh
  • LeSotho
  • Maceo
  • Maldives
  • Nambia
  • Pakistan
  • Samoa
  • South Africa
  • Sri Lanka
  • Swaziland
  • Uganda
  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6477)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6478) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 16A), Plug Type #25

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #25 (CEI 23-16). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6478 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: Chile, Italy, Libya.

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6478)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6479) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #6

(No Longer Available as of June 24, 2005)

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #6 (AS 3112-1964 NZS 198). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6479 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord:

  • Australia
  • Fiji Islands
  • Kiribati
  • Nauru
  • New Zealand
  • Papua New Guinea
  • W. Samoa
  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6479)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6487) Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall, (250V, 15A), United States, Plug Type #5

(No Longer Available as of May 27, 2011)

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #5 (NEMA 6-15). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. 6-foot length. The following countries/regions use the #6487 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: United States, Anguilla, Antigua & Barbuda, Aruba, Bahamas, Barbados, Belize, Bermuda, Bolivia, Bonnaire, Caicos Is., Canada, Cayman Islands, Colombia, Costa Rica, Cuba, Curacao, Dominican Republic, Ecuador, El Salvador, Guam, Guatamala, Haiti, Honduras, Jamaica, Japan, Micronesia, Montserrat, Netherlands Antilles, Nicaragua, Panama, Peru, Philippines, St. Marten NA, Taiwan, Tortola (BVI), Thailand, Venezuela.

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6487)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6488) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (125V, 15A or 250V, 10A), Plug Type #2

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6488 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: Argentina, Paraguay, Uruguay.

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6488)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6493) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #62

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #62 (GB 1053). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6493 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: People's Republic of China.

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6493)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6494) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #69

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #69 (IS 6538). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6494 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: India.

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6494)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6495) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #64

(No longer available as of August 29, 2008)

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #64. Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6495 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: Brazil.

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6495)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6496) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #66

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #66 (KETI). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6496 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: North Korea, South Korea.

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6496)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6497) Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 15A), Plug Type #10

(No Longer Available as of December 10, 2004)

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #10 (NEMA L6-15). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6497 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord:

  • Canada
  • Colombia
  • Japan
  • Mexico
  • United States
  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6497)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6498) Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 15A), Plug Type #34

(No Longer Available as of December 10, 2004)

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #34 (RS 3720U-2). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-43700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6498 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: Canada, Japan, United States.

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6498)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6592) Ultra320 SCSI 4-Pack

(No Longer Available as of May 28, 2010)

This feature provides an enclosure that can contain up to 4 Ultra320 SCSI disk drives.

  • Attributes provided: Enclosure for up to 4 disk drives
  • Attributes required: Empty enclosure location.
  • For 9113-550: (#6592)
    • Minimum required: 1
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6593) Ultra320 SCSI 4-Pack for Disk Mirroring

(No Longer Available as of May 28, 2010)

This feature provides an enclosure that can contain up to 4 Ultra320 SCSI disk drives. Used for disk mirroring and requires Feature Number 5712, the PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI Adapter or Feature Number 5703, the PCI-X Dual Channel Ultra320 SCSI RAID Adapter or a follow-on, and Feature Number 4267 or 4274, the PCI-X adapter to hot-swap disk enclosure cable.

  • Attributes provided: Enclosure for up to 4 disk drives
  • Attributes required: Empty enclosure location.
  • For 9113-550: pp(#6593)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6598) - Disk Slot Fillers (Quantity 4)

This feature allows the customer to move disks from the system to another system or an IO drawer and to place a blank disk filler in the empty disk slot. Systems shipped from manufacturing have blank filler in the empty disk slots.

  • Attributes provided: 4 disk slot fillers
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6598)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6651) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (125V, 15A), Plug Type #75

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #75 (KETI). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6651 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: Taiwan

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6651)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6659) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 15A), Plug Type #76

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #76 (KETI). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6659 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: Taiwan

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6659)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6660) Power Cord (14-foot), Drawer To OEM PDU (125V, 15A), Plug Type #59 (DENAN marking)

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #59 (NEMA 5-15). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. 14-foot length. This power cord meets the DENAN marking requirement in Japan.

  • Attributes provided: Power Cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6660)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6669) Power Cord (14-foot), Drawer to OEM PDU, (250V, 15A), Plug Type #57 (DENAN marking)

This power cord goes from the system or I/O drawer to the rack power distribution unit. Plug type #57 (NEMA 6-15). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. 14-foot length. This power cord meets the DENAN marking requirement in Japan.

  • Attributes provided: Power Cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6669)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6670) Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall (125V, 15A), Plug Type #59 (DENAN marking)

(No longer available as of August 29, 2008)

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #59 (NEMA 5-15). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. 6-foot length. This power cord meets the DENAN marking requirement in Japan.

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6670)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6671) - Power Cord (9-foot), Drawer to IBM PDU, 250V/10A

Standard IBM rack power cable that goes from the system or I/O drawer to the rack power distribution unit (PDU). 9-foot length.

  • Attributes provided: Power Cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6671)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No mzx (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6672) - Power Cord 2M (6.5-foot), Drawer to IBM PDU, 250V/10A

Standard rack power cable that goes from the system or I/O drawer to the rack power distribution unit (PDU). 6.5-foot length.

  • Attributes provided: Power Cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6672)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required:
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6680) Power Cord (9-foot), To Wall/OEM PDU, (250V, 10A), Plug Type #6, Insulated

This insulated power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #6 (AS 3112-1964 NZS 198). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. The following countries/regions use the #6479 power cord to power the system and/or peripheral features requiring a power cord: Australia, Fiji Islands, Kiribati, Nauru, New Zealand, Papua New Guinea, W. Samoa.

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6680)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#6687) Power Cord (6-foot), To Wall, (250V, 15A), Plug Type #57 (DENAN marking)

(No longer available as of August 29, 2008)

This power cord goes from the system and/or peripheral features to a wall-type outlet. Plug type #57 (NEMA 6-15). Refer to Corporate Bulletin C-B-2-4700-009 for a description of plug types. 6-foot length. This power cord meets the DENAN marking requirement in Japan.

  • Attributes provided: Power cord
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#6687)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#7162) IBM/OEM Rack-mount Drawer Rail Kit

(No Longer Available as of January 4, 2010)

This feature provides a rack rail kit used to install a rack-mount system in an IBM or OEM 19-inch rack.

  • Attributes provided:
  • Attributes required:
  • For 9113-550: (#7162)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: Feature #7162 or #7163 must be ordered if feature #7886 or #7874 is ordered.

(#7163) OEM Rack-mount Drawer Rail Kit

(No Longer Available as of May 12, 2005)

This feature provides a rack rail kit used to install a rack-mount system in an OEM 19-inch rack.

  • Attributes provided:
  • Attributes required:
  • For 9113-550: (#7163)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: Feature #7162 or #7163 must be ordered if feature #7886 or #7874 is ordered.

(#7305) AAP Software Pre-Install Indicator

Software pre-install indicator for Authorized Assemblers

  • Attributes provided: Software Preinstall
  • Attributes required: Authorized Assembler Order
  • For 9113-550: (#7305)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#7549) - Quantity 150 of #3647

(No Longer Available as of February 8, 2013)

Ships a quantity 150 of #3647 146GB 15K RPM SAS Disk Drive

  • Attributes provided: 150 of #3647 for every #7549
  • Attributes required: Available 3.5-inch SAS disk bay
  • For 9113-550: (#7549)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required:
      • IBM i - not supported
      • AIX 5.3 with the 5300-07 Technology Level or later.
      • AIX 6.1 or later.
      • SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 10 SP1 for POWER Systems, or later.
      • Red Hat Enterprise LInux for POWER, version 4.5, or later.
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux for POWER, version 5.1, or later.
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: VIOS attachment requires VIOS 2.1.2.0 or later

(#7564) - Quantity 150 of #3648

(No Longer Available as of February 8, 2013)

Quantity of 150 of #3648

  • Attributes provided: 150 #3648 for each #7564
  • Attributes required: Available 3.5-inch SAS disk bays
  • For 9113-550: (#7564)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required:
      • IBM i - not supported
      • AIX 5.3 with the 5300-07 Technology Level or later.
      • AIX 6.1 or later. SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 10 SP1 for POWER Systems, or later.
      • Red Hat Enterprise LInux for POWER, version 4.5, or later.
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux for POWER, version 5.1, or later.
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: VIOS attachment requires VIOS 2.1.2.0 or later

(#7565) - Quantity 150 of #3649

(No Longer Available as of February 8, 2013)

Quantity 150 of #3649 450GB 15K RPM SAS Disk Drive

  • Attributes provided: 150 #3649
  • Attributes required: Available 3.5-inch SAS disk bays
  • For 9113-550: (#7565)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required:
      • IBM i - not supported
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-09 Technology Level
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-06 Technology Level and Service Pack 10
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-07 Technology Level and Service Pack 7
      • AIX 5L for POWER version 5.3 with the 5300-08 Technology Level and Service Pack 5
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-02 Technology Level
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-00 Technology Level and Service Pack 7
      • AIX Version 6.1 with the 6100-01 Technology Level and Service Pack 3
      • SUSE Linux Enterprise Server 10 SP1 for POWER Systems or later.
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux for POWER version 4.5 or later.
      • Red Hat Enterprise Linux for POWER version 5.1 or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: VIOS attachment requires VIOS 2.1.2.0 or later

(#7601) - One Processor Entitlement for Processor Feature #5239

(No Longer Available as of April 25, 2014)

This feature number will permanently entitle the processor on a 5239 processor card.

  • Attributes provided: Entitlement of processor for #5239
  • Attributes required: Feature #5239 with non-entitled processor
  • For 9113-550: (#7601)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#7603) One Processor Activation for Processor Feature #5264

(No Longer Available as of April 25, 2014)

This feature number will activate the first or second processor on the first or second processor feature number 5264.

  • Attributes provided: Activation of processor(s) for #5264
  • Attributes required: Feature number 5264
  • For 9113-550: (#7603)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#7801) Ethernet Cable, 6M, Hardware Management Console to System Unit

(No Longer Available as of January 4, 2010)

This feature provides a six meter long Ethernet cable for attachment of a Hardware Management Console to the system unit.

  • Attributes provided: 6M Ethernet Cable
  • Attributes required: Ethernet port on Hardware Management Console
  • For 9113-550: (#7801)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#7802) Ethernet Cable, 15M, Hardware Management Console to System Unit

This feature provides a fifteen meter long Ethernet cable for attachment of a Hardware Management Console to the system unit.

  • Attributes provided: 15M Ethernet Cable
  • Attributes required: Ethernet port on Hardware Management Console
  • For 9113-550: (#7802)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#7871) One Processor Activation for CUoD Processor Feature #5237

(No Longer Available as of April 25, 2014)

This feature number will activate the first or second processor on the first or second processor feature number 5237.

  • Attributes provided: Activation of processor(s) for #5237
  • Attributes required: Feature numbers 5237
  • For 9113-550: (#7871)
    • Minimum required: 1
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#7876) Processor Power Regulator

(No Longer Available as of January 4, 2010)

This feature is required on the model 550 when a processor is installed in a processor slot. At least one is required since a model 550 requires one processor card in the minimum configuration. The regulator provides the needed power/voltage to allow the processors to operate.

  • Attributes provided: Power regulator
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#7876)
    • Minimum required: 1
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#7877) Media Backplane

(No Longer Available as of May 28, 2010)

This feature is required to support the system control panel and any IDE media device installed in the system.

  • Attributes provided: IDE Media Backplane Card
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#7877)
    • Minimum required: 1
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#7886) IBM Rack-mount Drawer Bezel and Hardware

(No longer available as of August 29, 2008)

Indicates that this order is for a rack-mount system requiring IBM bezel and hardware.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#7886)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: Either feature #7887, #7917, #7886, or #7874 must be on initial order.

(#7887) IBM Deskside Cover Set

(No longer available as of August 29, 2008)

Indicates that this order is for a deskside system requiring IBM cover set.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#7887)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: Either feature #7887, #7917, #7886, or #7874 must be on initial order.

(#7889) Power Supply, 1475 watt AC, Hot-swap, Base and Redundant

(No Longer Available as of January 4, 2010)

This feature provides an 1475 watt AC power supply, either as the primary power supply in the system, or the secondary power supply for redundant power. A power cord must be ordered for each power supply ordered.

  • Attributes provided: 1475 watt AC Power Supply
  • Attributes required: Available Power Supply Bay
  • For 9113-550: (#7889)
    • Minimum required: 1
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#7930) On/Off Processor Enablement for CoD

The enablement feature, when ordered, gives the customer the authority to self manage the amount of On/Off resources used. In order to obtain this enablement feature, the customer must sign a contract which obligates them to provide IBM with a monthly usage report. This feature includes a usage monitor which tracks the customer managed amount of activated processors.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#7930)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#7931) On/Off Processor Billing for CoD

Billing for On/Off is implemented by how many processor days are used. This feature is used to bill the customer for the amount of On/Off resources used.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: Feature Number 7930
  • For 9113-550: (#7931)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 90 (Initial order maximum: 0)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#7934) 30 Days Prepaid Reserve Capacity for CoD

This feature allows a customer to pre-purchase 30 processor days of usage time for CoD.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#7934)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.3, or later. SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later, Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS for POWER, Version 3, or later.
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#7941) Advanced POWER Virtualization

This feature allows the customer to create partitions that are in units of less than 1 CPU (sub-CPU LPARs) and allows the same system I/O to be virtually allocated to these partitions. When Virtualization is installed in the system, all activated processors must have the Virtualization feature. A fully activated 2-way system requires that two of this feature be ordered. A fully activated 4-way system requires that four of this feature be ordered.

An encrypted key is supplied to the customer and is intalled on the system, authorizing the partitioning at the sub-processor level.

Partitioan Load Manager is included to provide cross partition workload management across the partition.

  • Attributes provided: Capability to partition processor
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#7941)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 4 (Initial order maximum: 4)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.3, or later. SUSE LINUX Enterprise Server 9 for POWER, or later, Red Hat Enterprise Linux AS for POWER, Version 3, or later
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8131) 128-Port Asynchronous Controller Cable, 4.5 Meter

(No Longer Available as of June 23, 2006)

This cable provides attachment between the 128-port Asynchronous Controller and the first RAN in a daisy chain, or attachment between RANs in the daisy chain.

  • Attributes provided: Links 128-port Async Controller to RAN or RAN-to-RAN
  • Attributes required: (1) 128-port Async Controller or RAN-to-RAN connection in a daisy chain.
  • For 9113-550: (#8131)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8132) 128-Port Asynchronous Controller Cable, 23cm (9-Inch)

(No Longer Available as of June 23, 2006)

This cable may be substituted for the 4.5 meter (15 foot) async controller cable whenever a customer configuration requires stacked Remote Async Nodes.

  • Attributes provided: Links 128-port Async Controller to RAN or RAN-to-RAN
  • Attributes required: (1) 128-port Async Controller or RAN-to-RAN connection in a daisy chain.
  • For 9113-550: (#8132)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8133) RJ-45 to DB-25 Converter Cable

(No Longer Available as of November 26, 2010)

This cable can be used to attach EIA-232 devices to the 16 port EIA 232 Remote Async Node (FC 8130 or FC 8134) for the 128-Port Async subsystem. This cable provides a 25-pin D shell connector for device attachment. Four cables are provided per each order.

  • Attributes provided: 4 DB-25 EIA-232 ports
  • Attributes required: 4 RJ-45 ports from a RAN (8130, 8134, 8136)
  • For 9113-550: (#8133)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8136) Rack Mountable Remote Asynchronous Node 16-Port EIA-232

(No Longer Available as of March 31, 2006)

The Rack Mountable Remote Asynchronous Node 16-Port EIA-232 (RAN) is a modified version of the existing 16-port Remote Async Node (feature #8130 or 8134) in an industry-standard 19-inch rack mount chassis to allow simpler installation and ease-of-use. Like the existing RAN, it can also be configured as a desktop device.

As an additional benefit, the metal chassis meets FCC Class B/CISPR B when used with similarly rated RS/6000 host to meet the needs of customers with these requirements.

The RANs provide 16 ports of EIA-232 capability with full modem controls on each port and are connected to the 128-port Async Controller (Micro Channel or ISA versions) residing in the host. RANs are connected in daisy-chain fashion up to 8 RANs per 128-port Async Controller (either version).

The rack-mountable RAN offers these enhanced features:

  • Industry-standard 19-inch rack mountable chassis (can be configured for stacking on a desktop or mounted in a 19-inch rack).
  • Meets FCC Class B/CISPR B when used with similarly rated RS/6000 host.
  • All RJ-45 connectors are now on the front panel, greatly enhancing cable management.
  • The DB-15 synchronous connectors (cabling from host to RAN and between RANs) and the power cord and switch are located on the rear panel.
  • Power supply is self contained within the unit.

The rack-mountable RAN offers these same features as the existing RAN product:

  • Identical function and support as existing 16-port Remote Async Node (RAN), feature #8130 or 8134.
  • Operation of 16 to 128 ports by supporting up to 8 RANs (4 per synchronous line) with either a Micro Channel or ISA host adapter.
  • Ability to monitor individual port operation, synchronous line station, and other diagnostics from front panel.
  • Built-in diagnostics can test ports independent of RS/6000 host.
  • Full modem control supports the following interface signals: TxD, RxD, RTS, CTS, DSR, DCD, DTR, RI.
  • The same RJ-45 to DB-25 Converter Cable (feature #8133 -- quantity four per order) currently used on the existing RANs can be used to attach devices having a DB-25 connector to the Remote Async Nodes.
  • Individual ports support a maximum EIA-232 distance of 62 meters (200 feet).
  • Use of the same cabling from host to RAN and RAN to RAN: feature #8131 (4.5 meter), feature #8132 (23 cm) or customer-supplied cables.
  • Location of RAN up to 330 meters from the host using standard shielded 8-wire twisted pair cabling.
  • Remote operation via synchronous modems or CSU/DSU extends the distance and allows location of RANs at geographically distant location from the host.
  • Attributes provided: 16 RJ-45 EIA-232 ports AND 1 RAN-to-RAN connection
  • Attributes required: 1 RAN-to-128-port Controller connection OR 1 RAN-to-RAN connection
  • For 9113-550: (#8136)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 16 (Initial order maximum: 16)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

    Note: Maximum of 8 per #2944 -- 128-port asynch adapter

(#8137) Enhanced Remote Asynchronous Node 16-Port EIA-232

(No Longer Available as of March 31, 2006)

Provides remote connection of up to 16 EIA-232 devices to a 128-Port Asynchronous Controller.

Each port can be individually programmed to provide a asynchronous connection of 230 Kbaud, but a limited number of ports in a maximum configuration (128 ports) can be supported at this baud rate.

  • Operation of 16 to 128 ports by supporting up to 8 RANs (4 per synchronous line) with either a Micro Channel, ISA or PCI host adapter.
  • Ability to monitor individual port operation, synchronous line station, and other diagnostics from front panel.
  • Built-in diagnostics can test ports independent of RS/6000 host.
  • Full modem control supports the following interface signals: TxD, RxD, RTS, CTS, DSR, DCD, DTR, RI.
  • The same RJ-45 to DB-25 Converter Cable (feature #8133 -- quantity four per order) currently used on the existing RANs can be used to attach devices having a DB-25 connector to the Remote Async Nodes.
  • Individual ports support a maximum EIA-232 distance of up to 31 meters (100 feet), depending on the baud rate.
  • Use of the same cabling from host to RAN and RAN to RAN: feature #8131 (4.5 meter), feature #8132 (23 cm) or customer supplied cables.
  • Location of RAN up to 330 meters (sync data rate set at 1.2 Mbps) from host using standard shielded 8-wire twisted pair cabling.
  • Remote operation via synchronous modems or CSU/DSU extends the distance and allows location of RANs at geographically distant location from the host.
  • Attributes provided: 16 EIA-232 Async ports
  • Attributes required: One 128-port adapter per eight (#8137s)
  • For 9113-550: (#8137)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: No max (Initial order maximum: No max)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8450) Zero-priced Value Pak Processor Activation Code for #5237

(No Longer Available as of April 25, 2014)

This feature number will provide a customer with one or two free processor activations. Only available with IBM p5 550 Value Paks.

  • Attributes provided: Activation of processor(s) for #5237
  • Attributes required: Qualifying model 550 Value Paks
  • For 9113-550: (#8450)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8463) Zero-priced Value Pak Processor Entitlement for #5239

(No Longer Available as of April 25, 2014)

This feature provides a customer with one processor entitlement at no additional charge. Available only with IBM eServer p5 Model 550 Value Paks.

  • Attributes provided: One processor entitlement for #5239
  • Attributes required: Qualifying Model 550 Value Pak
  • For 9113-550: (#8463)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. For Linux, refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8465) Zero-priced Value Pak Processor Activation Code for #5264

(No Longer Available as of April 25, 2014)

This feature provides a customer with one or two processor activations at no additional charge. Available only with IBM eServer p5 Model 550 Value Paks.

  • Attributes provided: Activation of processor(s) for #5264
  • Attributes required: Qualifying Model 550 Value Pak
  • For 9113-550: (#8465)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 2 (Initial order maximum: 2)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later. for Linux, refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/hardware/
      factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8800) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, US English, #103P

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached US English #103P keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8800)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8801) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, French, #189

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached French #189 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8801)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8802) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Italian, #142

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Italian #142 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8802)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8803) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, German/Austrian, #129

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached German/Austrian #129 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8803)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8804) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, UK English, #166

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached UK English #166 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8804)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8805) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Spanish, #172

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Spanish #172 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8805)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8806) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Japanese, #194

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Japanese #194 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8806)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8807) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Brazilian/Portuguese, #275

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Brazilian Portuguese #275 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8807)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8808) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Canadian French, #058

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Canadian French #058 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8808)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8810) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Belgian/Dutch, #120

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Belgian/Dutch #120 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8810)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8811) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Swedish/Finnish, #153

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Swedish/Finnish #153 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8811)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8812) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Danish, #159

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Danish #159 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8812)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8813) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Bulgarian, #442

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Bulgarian #442 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8813)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8814) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Swiss/French/German, #150F/G

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Swiss/French/German #150F/G keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8814)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8816) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Norwegian, #155

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Norwegian #155 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8816)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8817) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Dutch, #143

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

  • Attributes provided:
  • Attributes required:
  • For 9113-550: (#8817)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None.
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8818) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Portuguese, #163

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Portuguese #163 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8818)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8819) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Greek, #319

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Greek #319 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8819)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8820) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Hebrew, #212

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Hebrew #212 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8820)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8821) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Hungarian, #208

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Hungarian #208 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8821)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8823) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Polish, #214

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Polish #214 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8823)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8825) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Slovakian, #245

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Slovakian #245 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8825)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8826) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Czech, #243

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Czech #243 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8826)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8827) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Turkish, #179

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Turkish #179 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8827)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8829) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, LA Spanish, #171

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached LA Spanish #171 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8829)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8830) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Arabic, #238

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Arabic #238 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8830)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8833) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Korean, #413

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Korean #413 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8833)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8834) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Chinese/US, #467

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Chinese/US #467 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8834)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8835) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, French Canadian, #445

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached French Canadian #445 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8835)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8836) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Thai, #191

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Thai #191 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8836)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8838) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Russian, #443

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Russian #443 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8838)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8839) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, Yugoslavian/Latin, #105

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached Yugoslavian/Latin #105 keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8839)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8840) Quiet Touch Keyboard - USB, Business Black, US English (EMEA), #103P

(No Longer Available as of January 26, 2007)

This feature provides a USB attached US English #103P (EMEA) keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: Keyboard
  • Attributes required: USB Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8840)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: AIX 5.2 or AIX 5.3, or later Linux - Refer to the following URL for systems and features that operate with Linux:
      http://www.ibm.com/servers/eserver/pseries/
      hardware/factsfeatures.html
       
      
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8841) Mouse - Business Black with Keyboard Attachment Cable

(No Longer Available as of December 31, 2009)

This feature provides a three button mouse and a cable for attachment to a keyboard.

  • Attributes provided: 3-Button Mouse
  • Attributes required: Keyboard with Mouse Attachment Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8841)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: Linux
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#8845) - USB Mouse

The optical LED USB Mouse has 2 buttons and a scroll wheel that acts as a third button. Mouse cable is 1.8 meters long. OS does not support scrolling with the wheel. Business black with red scroll wheel.

  • Attributes provided: 2-Button USB Mouse w/scroll wheel that acts as 3rd button.
  • Attributes required: USB attachment Port
  • For 9113-550: (#8845)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: Linux
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: MES
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#9004) Southern Hemisphere Designator for Monitors

Specifies that southern hemisphere models are required for all CRT monitors on the initial plant order or on MES orders. Not required with TFT monitors.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: Monitor
  • For 9113-550: (#9004)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Both
    • CSU: Yes
    • Return parts MES: No

(#9169) - Order Routing Indicator - System Plant

This feature will be auto-selected by the Configurator Tool when required. Use of this feature will affect the routing of the order. Selection of this indicator will direct the order to a system plant for fulfillment.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9169)
    • Minimum required:
    • Maximum allowed: (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9300) Language Group Specify - US English

English language group for nomenclature and standard publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9300)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9700) Language Group Specify - Dutch

Dutch language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9700)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9703) Language Group Specify - French

French language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9703)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9704) Language Group Specify - German

German language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9704)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9705) Language Group Specify - Polish

Polish language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: none
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#9705)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9707) Language Group Specify - Portuguese

Portuguese language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9707)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9708) Language Group Specify - Spanish

Spanish language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9708)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9711) Language Group Specify - Italian

Italian language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9711)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9712) Language Group Specify - Canadian French

Canadian French language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9712)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9714) Language Group Specify - Japanese

Japanese language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9714)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9715) Language Group Specify - Traditional Chinese (Taiwan)

Traditional Chinese language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9715)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9716) Language Group Specify - Korean

Korean language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9716)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9718) Language Group Specify - Turkish

Turkish language group for nomenclature and publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9718)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9719) Language Group Specify - Hungarian

Hungarian language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: none
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#9719)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9720) Language Group Specify - Slovakian

Slovakian language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: none
  • Attributes required: none
  • For 9113-550: (#9720)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9721) Language Group Specify - Russian

Russian language group for nomenclature and standard publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9721)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9722) Language Group Specify - Simplified Chinese (PRC)

Simplified Chinese language group for nomenclature and standard publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9722)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9724) Language Group Specify - Czech

Czech language group for nomenclature and standard publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9724)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9725) Language Group Specify - Romanian

Romanian language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9725)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

(#9727) Language Group Specify - Slovenian

Slovenian language group for Nomenclature and Standard Publications.

  • Attributes provided: None
  • Attributes required: None
  • For 9113-550: (#9727)
    • Minimum required: 0
    • Maximum allowed: 1 (Initial order maximum: 1)
    • OS level required: None
    • Initial Order/MES/Both/Supported: Initial
    • CSU: Does not apply
    • Return parts MES: Does not apply

Feature exchanges

Not available.
Back to topBack to top
 

Accessories

None.

Customer replacement parts

None.
Back to topBack to top
 

Machine elements

None.
Back to topBack to top
 

Supplies

None.

Supplemental media

None.

Trademarks

(R), (TM), * Trademark or registered trademark of International Business Machines Corporation.

** Company, product, or service name may be a trademark or service mark of others.

Windows is a trademark of Microsoft Corporation.
 © IBM Corporation 2014.
Back to topBack to top